blob: 786e5c3c1eb695de39c84430dc0e3428c3443c86 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreauf08137c2017-10-22 10:13:45 +02007 2017/10/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200545 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200546 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100548 - presetenv
549 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200550 - uid
551 - ulimit-n
552 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100553 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200554 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200555 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-bind-options
557 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
558 - ssl-default-server-options
559 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100560 - ssl-server-verify
Christopher Faulet62519022017-10-16 15:49:32 +0200561 - thread-map
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100562 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100563 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100564 - 51degrees-data-file
565 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200566 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200567 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100568 - wurfl-data-file
569 - wurfl-information-list
570 - wurfl-information-list-separator
571 - wurfl-engine-mode
572 - wurfl-cache-size
573 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200576 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200578 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100579 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100580 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100581 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200582 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200583 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200584 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200586 - noepoll
587 - nokqueue
588 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100589 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300590 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000591 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200592 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200593 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200594 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000595 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000596 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200597 - tune.buffers.limit
598 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200599 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200600 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100601 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100602 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200603 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200604 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100605 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100606 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100607 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100608 - tune.lua.session-timeout
609 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200610 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100611 - tune.maxaccept
612 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200613 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200614 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200615 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100616 - tune.rcvbuf.client
617 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100618 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100619 - tune.sndbuf.client
620 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100621 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100622 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200623 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100624 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200625 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200626 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100627 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200628 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100629 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200630 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
631 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
632 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100633 - tune.zlib.memlevel
634 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100635
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636 * Debugging
637 - debug
638 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639
640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006413.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200642------------------------------------
643
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200644ca-base <dir>
645 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200646 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
647 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200648
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200649chroot <jail dir>
650 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
651 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
652 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
653 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
654 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
655 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100656
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100657cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
658 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
659 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
660 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100661 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
662 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
663 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
664 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
665 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
666 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
667 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
668 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
669 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
670 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100671
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200672crt-base <dir>
673 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
674 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
675 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
676
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200677daemon
678 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
679 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
680 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
681
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200682deviceatlas-json-file <path>
683 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
684 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
685
686deviceatlas-log-level <value>
687 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
688 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
689
690deviceatlas-separator <char>
691 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
692 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
693
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100694deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200695 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
696 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
697 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100698
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900699external-check
700 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
701 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
702 See "option external-check".
703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704gid <number>
705 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
706 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
707 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100708 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
709 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200710 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100711
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100712hard-stop-after <time>
713 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
714
715 Arguments :
716 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
717 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
718 SIGUSR1 signal.
719
720 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
721 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
722 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
723
724 Example:
725 global
726 hard-stop-after 30s
727
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728group <group name>
729 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
730 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100731
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200732log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200733 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
734 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100735 configured with "log global".
736
737 <address> can be one of:
738
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100739 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100740 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
741 port).
742
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100743 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
744 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
745 port).
746
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100747 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
748 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
749 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
750 writeable).
751
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200752 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
753 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100754
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200755 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
756 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
757 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
758 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
759 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
760 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
761 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
762 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
763 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
764 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200765 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
766 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200767
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200768 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
769 one of the following :
770
771 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
772 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
773
774 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
775 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
776
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100777 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200778
779 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
780 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
781 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
782
783 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200784 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
785 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
786 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
787 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
788 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
789 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200791 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200792
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100793log-send-hostname [<string>]
794 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
795 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
796 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
797 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
798 the logs.
799
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000800log-tag <string>
801 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
802 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
803 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100804 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000805
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100806lua-load <file>
807 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
808 used multiple times.
809
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200810master-worker [exit-on-failure]
811 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
812 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
813 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
814 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
815 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
816 systemd.
817 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
818 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
819 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
820 the whole process.
821
822 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
823
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824nbproc <number>
825 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
826 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
827 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
828 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
829 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
830
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200831nbthread <number>
832 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
833 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
834 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
835 process. FOR NOW, THREADS SUPPORT IN HAPROXY IS HIGHLY EXPERIMENTAL AND IT
836 MUST BE ENABLED WITH CAUTION AND AT YOUR OWN RISK. See also "nbproc".
837
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200838pidfile <pidfile>
839 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
840 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
841 starting the process. See also "daemon".
842
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100843presetenv <name> <value>
844 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
845 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
846 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
847 and "unsetenv".
848
849resetenv [<name> ...]
850 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
851 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
852 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
853 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
854 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
855 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
856 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
857 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
858
Olivier Houchard9679ac92017-10-27 14:58:08 +0200859ssl-allow-0rtt
860 Allow using 0RTT on every listener. 0RTT is prone to various attacks, so be
861 sure to know the security implications before activating it.
862
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100863stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200864 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
865 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
866 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
867 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
868 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
869 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100870 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200871 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
872 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200873
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200874server-state-base <directory>
875 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200876 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
877 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200878
879server-state-file <file>
880 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
881 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
882 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
883 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
884 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
885 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
886 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
887 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200888 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
889 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200890
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100891setenv <name> <value>
892 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
893 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
894 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
895 and "unsetenv".
896
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100897ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
899 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300900 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100901 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
902 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
903 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
904 "bind" keyword for more information.
905
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100906ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
908 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
909 keyword to see available options.
910
911 Example:
912 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200913 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100914
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100915ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
917 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300918 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100919 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
920 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
921 information.
922
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100923ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
924 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
925 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
926 keyword to see available options.
927
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200928ssl-dh-param-file <file>
929 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
930 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
931 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
932 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
933 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200934 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
935 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
936 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
937 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200938 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
939 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
940 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
941
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100942ssl-server-verify [none|required]
943 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
944 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
945 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
946
Christopher Faulet62519022017-10-16 15:49:32 +0200947
948thread-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <"all"|"odd"|"even"|thread_num> <cpu-set>...
949 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
950 binds a thread to a specific CPU set. The process must be specified to allow
951 different mapping for different processes. For details about the arguments,
952 see "cpu-map" directive. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its
953 mapping and the one of the process on which it is attached. If the
954 intersection is null, no specific bind will be set for the thread.
955
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200956stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
957 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
958 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
959 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +0200960 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200961 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200962
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200963 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
964 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
965 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200966
967stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
968 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
969 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100970 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200971
972stats maxconn <connections>
973 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
974 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
975
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200976uid <number>
977 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
978 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
979 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
980 one. See also "gid" and "user".
981
982ulimit-n <number>
983 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
984 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
985 option.
986
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100987unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
988 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
989
990 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
991 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
992 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
993 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
994 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
995 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
996 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
997 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
998 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
999 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1000
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001001unsetenv [<name> ...]
1002 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1003 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1004 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1005 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1006 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1007 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1008 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1009
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001010user <user name>
1011 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1012 See also "uid" and "group".
1013
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001014node <name>
1015 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1016
1017 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1018 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1019 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1020 traffic.
1021
1022description <text>
1023 Add a text that describes the instance.
1024
1025 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1026 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1027 "<" and ">" characters.
1028
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100102951degrees-data-file <file path>
1030 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1031 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1032
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001033 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001034 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1035
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000103651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001037 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1038 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1039 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1040
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001041 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001042 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1043
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200104451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001045 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1046 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1047
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001048 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1049 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1050
105151degrees-cache-size <number>
1052 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1053 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1054 By default, this cache is disabled.
1055
1056 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001057 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1058
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001059wurfl-data-file <file path>
1060 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1061 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1062
1063 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1064 with USE_WURFL=1.
1065
1066wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1067 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1068 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1069 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1070
1071 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1072
1073 Valid WURFL properties are:
1074 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1075
1076 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1077 device.
1078
1079 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1080 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1081
1082 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1083 particular web request.
1084
1085 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1086 used Libwurfl API version.
1087
1088 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1089 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1090 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1091
1092 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1093 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1094
1095 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1096 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1097
1098 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1099
1100 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1101
1102 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1103 with USE_WURFL=1.
1104
1105wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1106 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1107 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1108
1109 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1110 with USE_WURFL=1.
1111
1112wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1113 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1114 thus before the chroot.
1115
1116 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1117 with USE_WURFL=1.
1118
1119wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1120 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1121 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1122 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1123 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1124 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1125 mode is enabled by default.
1126
1127 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1128 with USE_WURFL=1.
1129
1130wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1131 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1132 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1133 - "0" : no cache is used.
1134 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1135 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1136 the highest performing option.
1137
1138 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1139 with USE_WURFL=1.
1140
1141wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1142 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1143 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1144
1145 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1146 with USE_WURFL=1.
1147
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011493.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001150-----------------------
1151
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001152max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1153 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1154 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1155 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1156 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1157 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1158 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1159 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1160 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1161
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001162maxconn <number>
1163 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1164 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1165 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001166 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1167 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1168 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1169 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001170 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1171 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1172 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1173 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1174 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001175
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001176maxconnrate <number>
1177 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1178 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1179 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1180 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1181 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1182 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1183 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1184 fairness.
1185
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001186maxcomprate <number>
1187 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001188 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001189 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1190 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1191 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1192 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1193 default value.
1194
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001195maxcompcpuusage <number>
1196 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1197 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1198 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1199 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1200 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1201 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1202 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1203 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1204
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001205maxpipes <number>
1206 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1207 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1208 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1209 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1210 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1211 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1212
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001213maxsessrate <number>
1214 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1215 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1216 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1217 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1218 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1219 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1220 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1221 fairness.
1222
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001223maxsslconn <number>
1224 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1225 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1226 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1227 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1228 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1229 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1230 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001231 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1232 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1233 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1234 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1235 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1236 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1237 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001238
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001239maxsslrate <number>
1240 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1241 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1242 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1243 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1244 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1245 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1246 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1247 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1248 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1249 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1250
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001251maxzlibmem <number>
1252 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1253 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1254 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001255 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1256 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1257 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1258
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001259noepoll
1260 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1261 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001262 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001263
1264nokqueue
1265 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1266 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1267 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1268
1269nopoll
1270 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1271 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001272 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001273 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001274
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001275nosplice
1276 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1277 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1278 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001279 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001280 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1281 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1282 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1283 "option splice-response".
1284
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001285nogetaddrinfo
1286 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1287 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1288
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001289noreuseport
1290 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1291 command line argument "-dR".
1292
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001293spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001294 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1295 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1296 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1297 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1298 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1299 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001300
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001301ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1302 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1303 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1304 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1305 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1306 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1307 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1308 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1309 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1310 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1311 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1312 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1313 openssl configuration file uses:
1314 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1315
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001316ssl-mode-async
1317 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001318 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001319 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1320 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1321 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1322 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1323 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001324
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001325tune.buffers.limit <number>
1326 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1327 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1328 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1329 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1330 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1331 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1332 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1333 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1334 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1335 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1336 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1337 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1338 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1339 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1340 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1341
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001342tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1343 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1344 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1345 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1346 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1347
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001348tune.bufsize <number>
1349 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1350 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1351 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1352 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1353 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1354 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1355 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1356 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001357 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1358 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1359 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001360
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001361tune.chksize <number>
1362 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1363 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1364 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1365 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1366 checks whenever possible.
1367
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001368tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1369 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1370 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1371 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1372 this value. The default value is 1.
1373
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001374tune.http.cookielen <number>
1375 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1376 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1377 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1378 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1379 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1380 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1381 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1382 to change this value.
1383
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001384tune.http.logurilen <number>
1385 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1386 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1387 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1388 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1389 configuration directives too.
1390 The default value is 1024.
1391
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001392tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1393 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1394 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1395 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1396 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1397 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1398 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001399 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1400 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1401 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001402
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001403tune.idletimer <timeout>
1404 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1405 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1406 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1407 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1408 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1409 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1410 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1411 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1412 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1413
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001414tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1415 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001416 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001417 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1418 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1419 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1420 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1421 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1422
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001423tune.lua.maxmem
1424 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1425 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1426 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1427 memory.
1428
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001429tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1430 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001431 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1432 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1433 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001434
1435tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1436 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1437 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1438 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1439 check servers.
1440
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001441tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1442 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1443 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1444 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1445 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1446
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001447tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001448 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1449 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1450 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1451 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1452 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1453 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1454 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1455 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1456 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1457 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001458
1459tune.maxpollevents <number>
1460 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1461 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1462 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1463 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1464 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1465
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001466tune.maxrewrite <number>
1467 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1468 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1469 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1470 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1471 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1472 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1473 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1474 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1475 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1476 bufsize.
1477
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001478tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1479 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1480 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1481 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1482 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1483 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1484 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1485 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1486 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1487 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1488 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1489 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1490 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1491 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1492 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1493 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1494 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1495 setting this parameter to 0.
1496
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001497tune.pipesize <number>
1498 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1499 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1500 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1501 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1502 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1503 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1504
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001505tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1506tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1507 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1508 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1509 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1510 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1511 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1512 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1513 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1514
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001515tune.recv_enough <number>
1516 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1517 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1518 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1519 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1520 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1521
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001522tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1523tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1524 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1525 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1526 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1527 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1528 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1529 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1530 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1531 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1532 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1533 notifying haproxy again.
1534
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001535tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001536 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1537 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1538 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001539 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001540 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1541 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1542 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1543 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1544 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001545 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1546 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001547
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001548tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1549 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1550 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1551 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1552 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1553 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1554 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1555
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001556tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1557 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001558 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001559 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1560 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1561 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1562 being used for too long.
1563
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001564tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1565 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1566 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1567 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1568 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1569 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1570 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1571 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1572 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1573 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1574 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001575 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1576 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001577
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001578tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1579 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1580 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1581 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1582 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1583 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1584 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1585 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001586 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1587 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001588
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001589tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1590 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1591 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1592 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1593 1000 entries.
1594
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001595tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1596 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1597 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1598 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1599
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001600tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001601tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001602tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1603tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1604tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001605 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1606 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1607 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1608 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1609 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1610 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1611 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1612 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001613
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001614 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1615 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1616 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1617 all available space is consumed.
1618 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1619 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1620 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001621
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001622tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1623 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001624 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001625 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1626 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1627 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1628
1629tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1630 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1631 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1632 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1633 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016353.3. Debugging
1636--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001637
1638debug
1639 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1640 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1641 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1642 system startup.
1643
1644quiet
1645 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1646 line argument "-q".
1647
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016493.4. Userlists
1650--------------
1651It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1652http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1653it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1654
1655userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001656 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001657 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1658
1659group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001660 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001661 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1662 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1663
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001664user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1665 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001666 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1667 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001668 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1669 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001670 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001671 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001672
1673
1674 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001675 userlist L1
1676 group G1 users tiger,scott
1677 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001678
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001679 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1680 user scott insecure-password elgato
1681 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001682
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001683 userlist L2
1684 group G1
1685 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001686
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001687 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1688 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1689 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001690
1691 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001692
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001693
16943.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001695----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001696It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1697several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1698instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1699values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1700automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1701In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1702using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1703tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1704reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1705Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1706that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1707each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001708
1709peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001710 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001711 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1712
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001713disabled
1714 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1715 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1716 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1717
1718enable
1719 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1720
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001721peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1722 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1723 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1724 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1725 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1726 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1727 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1728
1729 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1730 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1731
1732 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1733 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1734 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1735 across all peers.
1736
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001737 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1738 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001739
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001740 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001741 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001742 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1743 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1744 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001745
1746 backend mybackend
1747 mode tcp
1748 balance roundrobin
1749 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1750 stick on src
1751
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001752 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1753 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001754
1755
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090017563.6. Mailers
1757------------
1758It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1759If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1760in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1761
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001762mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001763 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1764 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1765
1766mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1767 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1768
1769 Example:
1770 mailers mymailers
1771 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1772 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1773
1774 backend mybackend
1775 mode tcp
1776 balance roundrobin
1777
1778 email-alert mailers mymailers
1779 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1780 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1781
1782 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1783 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1784
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001785timeout mail <time>
1786 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1787 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1788 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1789 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1790
1791 Example:
1792 mailers mymailers
1793 timeout mail 20s
1794 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017964. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001797----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001799Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001800 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001801 - frontend <name>
1802 - backend <name>
1803 - listen <name>
1804
1805A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1806its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1807section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001808section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001809
1810A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1811connections.
1812
1813A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1814to forward incoming connections.
1815
1816A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1817parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001819All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1820'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1821case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1822
1823Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1824logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1825proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1826However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1827name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1828
1829Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1830and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001831bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001832protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1833modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1834arbitrary criteria.
1835
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001836In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1837a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1838the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1839
1840 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1841 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1842 between responses and new requests.
1843
1844 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1845 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1846 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1847 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1848
1849 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1850 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1851 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1852
1853 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1854 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1855 client-facing connection remains open.
1856
1857 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1858 after the end of the response.
1859
1860The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1861frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1862following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1863weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1864
1865 Backend mode
1866
1867 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1868 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1869 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1870 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1871 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1872 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1873 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1874 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1875 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1876 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1877 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1878
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001879
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018814.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1882--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001884The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1885limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1886they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1887limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001888marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001889option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001890and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1891with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1892specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001893
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001894
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001895 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1896------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1897acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001898appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001899backlog X X X -
1900balance X - X X
1901bind - X X -
1902bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001903block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001904capture cookie - X X -
1905capture request header - X X -
1906capture response header - X X -
1907clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001908compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001909contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1910cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001911declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001912default-server X - X X
1913default_backend X X X -
1914description - X X X
1915disabled X X X X
1916dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001917email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001918email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001919email-alert mailers X X X X
1920email-alert myhostname X X X X
1921email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001922enabled X X X X
1923errorfile X X X X
1924errorloc X X X X
1925errorloc302 X X X X
1926-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1927errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001928force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001929filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001930fullconn X - X X
1931grace X X X X
1932hash-type X - X X
1933http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001934http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001935http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001937http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001938http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001939http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001940id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001941ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001942load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001943log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001944log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001945log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001946log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001947max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001948maxconn X X X -
1949mode X X X X
1950monitor fail - X X -
1951monitor-net X X X -
1952monitor-uri X X X -
1953option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1954option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1955option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1956option allbackups (*) X - X X
1957option checkcache (*) X - X X
1958option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1959option contstats (*) X X X -
1960option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1961option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1962option forceclose (*) X X X X
1963-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1964option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001965option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001966option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001967option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001968option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001969option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001970option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001971option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001972option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1973option httpchk X - X X
1974option httpclose (*) X X X X
1975option httplog X X X X
1976option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001977option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001978option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001979option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001980option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1981option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1982option logasap (*) X X X -
1983option mysql-check X - X X
1984option nolinger (*) X X X X
1985option originalto X X X X
1986option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001987option pgsql-check X - X X
1988option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001989option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001990option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001991option smtpchk X - X X
1992option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1993option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1994option splice-request (*) X X X X
1995option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001996option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001997option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1998option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1999-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002000option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002001option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2002option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2003option tcpka X X X X
2004option tcplog X X X X
2005option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002006external-check command X - X X
2007external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002008persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2009rate-limit sessions X X X -
2010redirect - X X X
2011redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2012redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2013reqadd - X X X
2014reqallow - X X X
2015reqdel - X X X
2016reqdeny - X X X
2017reqiallow - X X X
2018reqidel - X X X
2019reqideny - X X X
2020reqipass - X X X
2021reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002022reqitarpit - X X X
2023reqpass - X X X
2024reqrep - X X X
2025-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002026reqtarpit - X X X
2027retries X - X X
2028rspadd - X X X
2029rspdel - X X X
2030rspdeny - X X X
2031rspidel - X X X
2032rspideny - X X X
2033rspirep - X X X
2034rsprep - X X X
2035server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002036server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002037server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002038source X - X X
2039srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002040stats admin - X X X
2041stats auth X X X X
2042stats enable X X X X
2043stats hide-version X X X X
2044stats http-request - X X X
2045stats realm X X X X
2046stats refresh X X X X
2047stats scope X X X X
2048stats show-desc X X X X
2049stats show-legends X X X X
2050stats show-node X X X X
2051stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002052-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2053stick match - - X X
2054stick on - - X X
2055stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002056stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002057stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002058tcp-check connect - - X X
2059tcp-check expect - - X X
2060tcp-check send - - X X
2061tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002062tcp-request connection - X X -
2063tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002064tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002065tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002066tcp-response content - - X X
2067tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002068timeout check X - X X
2069timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002070timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002071timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2072timeout connect X - X X
2073timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2074timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2075timeout http-request X X X X
2076timeout queue X - X X
2077timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002078timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002079timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2080timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002081timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002082transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002083unique-id-format X X X -
2084unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002085use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002086use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002087------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2088 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020914.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2092---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093
2094This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2095
2096
2097acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2098 Declare or complete an access list.
2099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2100 no | yes | yes | yes
2101 Example:
2102 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2103 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2104 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002106 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002107
2108
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002109appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2110 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002111 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2113 no | no | yes | yes
2114 Arguments :
2115 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2116 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2117
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002118 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002119 checked in each cookie value.
2120
2121 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2122 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2123 milliseconds.
2124
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002125 request-learn
2126 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2127 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2128 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2129 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2130 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2131 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2132
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002133 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2134 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2135 data following this prefix.
2136
2137 Example :
2138 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2139
2140 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2141 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2142
2143 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2144 2 modes are currently supported :
2145 - path-parameters :
2146 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2147 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2148 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2149 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2150 - query-string :
2151 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2152 query string.
2153
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002154 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2155 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2156 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002158 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2159 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002160
2161
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002162backlog <conns>
2163 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2165 yes | yes | yes | no
2166 Arguments :
2167 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2168 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002169 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002170
2171 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2172 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2173 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2174 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2175 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2176 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2177 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2178 backlog parameter.
2179
2180 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2181 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2182 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2183
2184 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2185
2186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002187balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002188balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002189 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2191 yes | no | yes | yes
2192 Arguments :
2193 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2194 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2195 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2196 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2197
2198 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2199 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2200 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2201 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002202 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002203 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002204 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2205 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2206 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2207 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2208 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2209 it, so that you don't worry.
2210
2211 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2212 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2213 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2214 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2215 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2216 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2217 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2218 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002220 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2221 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2222 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2223 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2224 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2225 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2226 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2227 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2228
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002229 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002230 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002231 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2232 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002233 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002234 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2235 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2236 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2237 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2238 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002239 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2240 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2241 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2242 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2243 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2244 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002245
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002246 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2247 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2248 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2249 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2250 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2251 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2252 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2253 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002254 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002255 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002256 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2257 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2258 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002259
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002260 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2261 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2262 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2263 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2264 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2265 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2266 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2267 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2268 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2269 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2270 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2271 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002272
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002273 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002274 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2275 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2276 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2277 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2278 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2279 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2280 URIs start with a leading "/".
2281
2282 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2283 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2284 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2285 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2286
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002287 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002288 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2289
2290 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002291 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2292 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002293 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2294 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2295 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2296 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002297 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002298 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2299 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002300
2301 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2302 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2303 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2304 server will receive the request.
2305
2306 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2307 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2308 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2309 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2310 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002311 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2312 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2313 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002314
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002315 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2316 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2317 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2318 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2319 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002320
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002321 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002322 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2323 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2324 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2325
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002326 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2327 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2328 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2329
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002330 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002331 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002332 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2333 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2334 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2335 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2336 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2337 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002338 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002339 used instead.
2340
2341 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2342 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2343 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2344 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2345
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002346 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2347 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2348 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2349
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002350 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002351
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002352 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002353 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2354 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002355
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002356 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2357 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2358 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002359
2360 Examples :
2361 balance roundrobin
2362 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002363 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002364 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2365 balance hdr(host)
2366 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002367
2368 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2369 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2370
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002371 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002372 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2373 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2374 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2375 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2376
2377 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2378 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2379 defaults to 16 kB.
2380
2381 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2382 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2383
2384 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2385 Round Robin.
2386
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002387 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002388 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2389 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2390 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2391
2392 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2393
2394 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002395 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002396 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2397 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2398 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002399
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002400 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002401
2402
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002403bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2404bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002405 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2407 no | yes | yes | no
2408 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002409 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2410 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2411 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2412 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002413 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002414 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2415 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2416 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2417 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2418 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2419 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2420 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002421 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2422 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2423 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2424 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2425 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2426 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2427 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002428 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2429 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2430 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002431 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2432 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2433 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002434
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002435 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2436 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002437 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2438 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2439 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002440 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2441 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2442 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2443 the range.
2444
2445 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2446 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2447 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2448 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2449 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2450 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2451 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002452 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002453 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002454
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002455 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2456 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2457 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2458 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2459 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2460 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2461 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2462 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2463
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002464 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2465 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2466 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2467 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002468
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002469 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2470 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2471 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2472 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2473 in a frontend.
2474
2475 Example :
2476 listen http_proxy
2477 bind :80,:443
2478 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002479 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002481 listen http_https_proxy
2482 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002483 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002484
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002485 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2486 bind ipv6@:80
2487 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2488 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2489
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002490 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002491 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002492
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002493 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2494 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2495 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2496 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2497 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2498
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002499 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002500 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002501
2502
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002503bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002504 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2506 yes | yes | yes | yes
2507 Arguments :
2508 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2509 may be used to override a default value.
2510
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002511 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002512 option may be combined with other numbers.
2513
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002514 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002515 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2516 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2517 missing from all processes.
2518
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002519 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002520 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002521 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2522 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2523 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2524 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002525
2526 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2527 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2528 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2529 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2530 and 'even' instances.
2531
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002532 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2533 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2534 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2535 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002536
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002537 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2538 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2539
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002540 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2541 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2542 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2543
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002544 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2545 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2546
2547 Example :
2548 listen app_ip1
2549 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002550 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002551
2552 listen app_ip2
2553 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002554 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002555
2556 listen management
2557 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002558 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002559
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002560 listen management
2561 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2562 bind-process 1-4
2563
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002564 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002565
2566
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002567block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002568 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2570 no | yes | yes | yes
2571
2572 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2573 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002574 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002575 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002576 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002577 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2578 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2579 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002580
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002581 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2582 "http-request deny" instead.
2583
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002584 Example:
2585 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2586 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2587 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002588 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2589 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2590 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002592 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2593 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2594 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002595
2596capture cookie <name> len <length>
2597 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2598 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2599 no | yes | yes | no
2600 Arguments :
2601 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2602 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2603 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2604 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2605 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2606
2607 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2608 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2609 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2610 right if it exceeds <length>.
2611
2612 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2613 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2614 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2615 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2616
2617 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2618 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2619 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2620
2621 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2622 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2623 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002624 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2625 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2626 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002627
2628 Example:
2629 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2630
2631 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002632 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002633
2634
2635capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002636 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2638 no | yes | yes | no
2639 Arguments :
2640 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002641 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002642 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2643 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2644 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2645
2646 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2647 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2648 it exceeds <length>.
2649
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002650 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002651 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2652 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002653 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2654 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2655 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2656 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002657 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002658 environments to find where the request came from.
2659
2660 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2661 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2662 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2663 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002664
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002665 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2666 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2667 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2668 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2669 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670
2671 Example:
2672 capture request header Host len 15
2673 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002674 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002675
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002676 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002677 about logging.
2678
2679
2680capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002681 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2683 no | yes | yes | no
2684 Arguments :
2685 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002686 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002687 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2688 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2689 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2690
2691 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2692 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2693 it exceeds <length>.
2694
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002695 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002696 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2697 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2698 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002699 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2700 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2701 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2702 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002703
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002704 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2705 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2706 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2707 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2708 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002709
2710 Example:
2711 capture response header Content-length len 9
2712 capture response header Location len 15
2713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002714 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715 about logging.
2716
2717
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002718clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2721 yes | yes | yes | no
2722 Arguments :
2723 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2724 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2725 as explained at the top of this document.
2726
2727 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2728 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2729 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2730 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2731 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2732 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2733 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2734 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002735 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2737 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2738
2739 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2740 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2741 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2742 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2743 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2744 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2745
2746 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2747 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2748
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002749 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2750 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002752compression algo <algorithm> ...
2753compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002754compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002755 Enable HTTP compression.
2756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2757 yes | yes | yes | yes
2758 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002759 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2760 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2761 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2762
2763 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002764 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2765 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2766 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002767
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002768 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002769 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002770
2771 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2772 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2773 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2774 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2775 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002776 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002777
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002778 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2779 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2780 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2781 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2782 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2783 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2784 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002785 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002786
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002787 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002788 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002789 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2790 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2791 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2792 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2793 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002794
2795 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2796 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2797 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2798 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2799 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002800 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2801 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2802 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2803 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2804 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002805 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2806 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002807
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002808 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002809 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2810 "Accept-Encoding" header
2811 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002812 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002813 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2814 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002815 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2816 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2817 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2818 "multipart"
2819 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2820 header
2821 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2822 and later
2823 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2824 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002825
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002826 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2827 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002828
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002829 Examples :
2830 compression algo gzip
2831 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002833
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002834contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002835 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2837 yes | no | yes | yes
2838 Arguments :
2839 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2840 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2841 as explained at the top of this document.
2842
2843 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002844 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002845 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2847 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2848 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2849 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2850
2851 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2852 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2853 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2854 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2855 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2856 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2857
2858 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2859 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2860 instead.
2861
2862 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2863 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2864
2865
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002866cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002867 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2868 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002869 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002870 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2872 yes | no | yes | yes
2873 Arguments :
2874 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2875 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2876 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2877 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2878 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2879 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2880 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2881 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2882 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2883
2884 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2885 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2886 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2887 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2888 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2889 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002890 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2891 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2892 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2893 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2894 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002895
2896 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002897 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002898
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002899 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002900 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2901 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2902 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2903 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2904 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2905 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2906 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2907 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2908 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2909 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002910
2911 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2912 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2913 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2914 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2915 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2916 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2917 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2918 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2919 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002920 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002921 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2922 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2923 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002925 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2926 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2927 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002928 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2929 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2930 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2931 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002932 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2933 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2934 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935
2936 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2937 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2938 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2939 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2940 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2941 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2942 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2943 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2944 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2945
2946 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2947 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2948 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2949 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2950 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2951 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2952 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2953 persistence cookie in the cache.
2954 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2955
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002956 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2957 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2958 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2959 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2960 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2961 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2962 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2963 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2964 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2965 they logout.
2966
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002967 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2968 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2969 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2970 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2971
2972 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2973 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2974 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2975 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2976 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2977 this attribute.
2978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002979 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002980 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002981 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2982 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2983 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2984 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2985 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2986 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002987
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002988 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2989 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2990 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2991 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2992 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2993 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2994 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2995 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2996 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2997 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2998 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2999 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3000 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3001 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3002 the site.
3003
3004 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3005 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3006 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3007 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3008 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3009 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3010 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3011 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3012 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3013 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3014 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3015 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3016 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
3017 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
3018 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3019 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3020
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003021 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3022 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3023 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3024 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3025 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3026 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3027
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003028 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3029 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3030 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3031 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033 Examples :
3034 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3035 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3036 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003037 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003038
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003039 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003040
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003041
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003042declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3043 Declares a capture slot.
3044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3045 no | yes | yes | no
3046 Arguments:
3047 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3048
3049 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3050 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3051 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3052 for use in the response.
3053
3054 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003055 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003056 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3057
3058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003059default-server [param*]
3060 Change default options for a server in a backend
3061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3062 yes | no | yes | yes
3063 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003064 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3065 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3066 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3067 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003068
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003069 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003070 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3071
3072 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003073
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003074
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003075default_backend <backend>
3076 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3078 yes | yes | yes | no
3079 Arguments :
3080 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3081
3082 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3083 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3084 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3085 will catch all undetermined requests.
3086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003087 Example :
3088
3089 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3090 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3091 default_backend dynamic
3092
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003093 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003095
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003096description <string>
3097 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3098 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3099 no | yes | yes | yes
3100 Arguments : string
3101
3102 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3103 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3104 it describes.
3105 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3106
3107
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003108disabled
3109 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3111 yes | yes | yes | yes
3112 Arguments : none
3113
3114 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3115 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3116 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3117 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3118 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3119 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3120 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3121
3122 See also : "enabled"
3123
3124
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003125dispatch <address>:<port>
3126 Set a default server address
3127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3128 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003129 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003130
3131 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3132 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3133 during start-up.
3134
3135 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3136 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3137 possible with normal servers.
3138
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003139 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003140 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3141 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3142 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3143 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3144
3145 See also : "server"
3146
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003147
3148dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3149 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3151 yes | no | yes | yes
3152 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3153
3154 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3155 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3156 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3157 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3158 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3159 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003160
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161enabled
3162 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3164 yes | yes | yes | yes
3165 Arguments : none
3166
3167 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3168 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3169
3170 See also : "disabled"
3171
3172
3173errorfile <code> <file>
3174 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3176 yes | yes | yes | yes
3177 Arguments :
3178 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003179 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3180 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003181
3182 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003183 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003185 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3186 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003187
3188 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3189 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3190 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3191
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003192 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3193
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003194 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3195 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3196 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3197 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3198
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003199 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3200 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3201 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3202 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3203 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3204 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3207 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3208 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003209 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003210 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3211
3212 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3213
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003214 Example :
3215 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003216 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003217 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3218 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3219
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003220
3221errorloc <code> <url>
3222errorloc302 <code> <url>
3223 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 yes | yes | yes | yes
3226 Arguments :
3227 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003228 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3229 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003230
3231 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3232 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3233 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3234 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3235 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3236
3237 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3238 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3239 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3240
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003241 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3242
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003243 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3244 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3245 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3246 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003247 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003248 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3249 request.
3250
3251 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3252
3253
3254errorloc303 <code> <url>
3255 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 yes | yes | yes | yes
3258 Arguments :
3259 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003260 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3261 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003262
3263 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3264 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3265 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3266 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3267 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3268
3269 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3270 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3271 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3272
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003273 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3274
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003275 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3276 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3277 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3278 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003279 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003280
3281 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3282
3283
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003284email-alert from <emailaddr>
3285 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3286 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3287 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3288 yes | yes | yes | yes
3289
3290 Arguments :
3291
3292 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3293
3294 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3295 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3296
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003297 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003298 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3299 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003300
3301
3302email-alert level <level>
3303 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3304 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3305 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3306 yes | yes | yes | yes
3307
3308 Arguments :
3309
3310 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3311 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3312 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3313
3314 By default level is alert
3315
3316 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3317 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3318 for the proxy.
3319
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003320 Alerts are sent when :
3321
3322 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3323 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3324 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3325 is notice or lower
3326 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3327 and a health check status update occurs
3328
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003329 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3330 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003331 section 3.6 about mailers.
3332
3333
3334email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3335 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3336 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3337 yes | yes | yes | yes
3338
3339 Arguments :
3340
3341 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3342
3343 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3344 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3345
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003346 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3347 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003348
3349
3350email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3351 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3352 mailers.
3353 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3354 yes | yes | yes | yes
3355
3356 Arguments :
3357
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003358 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003359
3360 By default the systems hostname is used.
3361
3362 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3363 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3364 for the proxy.
3365
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003366 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3367 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003368
3369
3370email-alert to <emailaddr>
3371 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3372 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3373 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3374 yes | yes | yes | yes
3375
3376 Arguments :
3377
3378 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3379
3380 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3381 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3382
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003383 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003384 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3385
3386
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003387force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3388 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3389 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3390 no | yes | yes | yes
3391
3392 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3393 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3394 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3395 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3396 marked down for maintenance operations.
3397
3398 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3399 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3400 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3401 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3402 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3403 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3404 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3405 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3406 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3407
3408 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3409 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3410 is used.
3411
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003412 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003413 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003414
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003415
3416filter <name> [param*]
3417 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3419 no | yes | yes | yes
3420 Arguments :
3421 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3422 referenced in section 9.
3423
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003424 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003425 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003426 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3427 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003428
3429 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3430 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3431
3432 Example:
3433 listen
3434 bind *:80
3435
3436 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3437 filter compression
3438 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3439
3440 compression algo gzip
3441 compression offload
3442
3443 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3444
3445 See also : section 9.
3446
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003447
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003448fullconn <conns>
3449 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3451 yes | no | yes | yes
3452 Arguments :
3453 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3454 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3455
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003456 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003457 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003458 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003459 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3460 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3461 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3462 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3463 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003464 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003465
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003466 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3467 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003468 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3469 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3470 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003471
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003472 Example :
3473 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3474 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3475 # connections.
3476 backend dynamic
3477 fullconn 10000
3478 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3479 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3480
3481 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3482
3483
3484grace <time>
3485 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003487 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003488 Arguments :
3489 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3490 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3491 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3492
3493 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3494 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003495 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003496 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3497
3498 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3499 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3500 simplify it.
3501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003503hash-balance-factor <factor>
3504 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | no | no | yes
3507 Arguments :
3508 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3509 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3510 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3511
3512 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3513 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3514 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3515 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3516 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3517 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3518 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3519
3520 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3521 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3522 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3523 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3524 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3525
3526 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3527
3528
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003529hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003530 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3531 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3532 yes | no | yes | yes
3533 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003534 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3535 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003536
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003537 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3538 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3539 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3540 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3541 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3542 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3543 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3544 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3545 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3546 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003547
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003548 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3549 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3550 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3551 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3552 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3553 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3554 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3555 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3556 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3557 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3558 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3559 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3560 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003561 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3562 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003563
3564 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3565
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003566 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003567 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3568 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3569 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003570 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3571 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3572 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003573
3574 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3575 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003576 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3577 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3578 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3579 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3580
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003581 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3582 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3583 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3584 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3585 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3586 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3587 parameter.
3588
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003589 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3590 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3591 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3592 used on strings.
3593
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003594 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3595
3596 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3597 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3598 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3599 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3600 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3601 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3602 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3603 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3604 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3605 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3606 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3607 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003608
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003609 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3610 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3611 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003612
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003613 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003614
3615
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003616http-check disable-on-404
3617 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003619 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003620 Arguments : none
3621
3622 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3623 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3624 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3625 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3626 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3627 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3628 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3629 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003630 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3631 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3632 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3633
3634 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3635
3636
3637http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003638 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003640 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003641 Arguments :
3642 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3643 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003644 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003645 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3646 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3647 details on the supported keywords.
3648
3649 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3650 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3651 with the usual backslash ('\').
3652
3653 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3654 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3655 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3656 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3657 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3658
3659 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003660 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003661 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3662 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3663 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3664
3665 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003666 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003667 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3668 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3669 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3670 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3671
3672 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003673 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003674 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3675 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3676 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3677 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3678 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3679 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3680 trace).
3681
3682 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003683 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003684 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3685 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3686 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3687 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3688 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3689 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3690
3691 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3692 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3693 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3694 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3695 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3696 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3697 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3698 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3699
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003700 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3701 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3702 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3703
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003704 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3705 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3706
3707 Examples :
3708 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003709 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003710
3711 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003712 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003713
3714 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003715 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003716
3717 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003718 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003719
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003720 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003721
3722
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003723http-check send-state
3724 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3726 yes | no | yes | yes
3727 Arguments : none
3728
3729 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3730 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3731 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3732 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3733 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3734
3735 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3736 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3737 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3738 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3739 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003740 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3741 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3742 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3743
3744 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3745 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3746 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3747
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003748 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3749 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3750 checked in multiple backends.
3751
3752 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3753 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3754
3755 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3756 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3757 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3758 one fails.
3759
3760 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3761 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3762 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3763
3764 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3765 server's queue.
3766
3767 Example of a header received by the application server :
3768 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3769 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3770
3771 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3772
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003773http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3774 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003775 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003776 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003777 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003778 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3779 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003780 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3781 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003782 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3783 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3784 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003785 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003786 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003787 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003788 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003789 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003790 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003791 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02003792 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003793 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003794 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003795 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3796
3797 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3798 no | yes | yes | yes
3799
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003800 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3801 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3802 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3803 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3804 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003805
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003806 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3807 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3808 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3809
3810 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003811 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3812 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3813 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3814 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003815
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003816 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3817 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3818 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003819 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3820 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003821 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3822 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3823 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3824 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3825 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003826 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003827 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3828 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003829
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003830 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3831 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3832 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3833 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3834 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3835
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003836 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3837 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3838 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003839 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3840 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003841
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003842 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3843 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3844 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3845 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3846 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3847 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3848 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3849 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3850
3851 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3852 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3853 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003854 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3855 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003856
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003857 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3858 <name>.
3859
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003860 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3861 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3862 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3863 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3864 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3865 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3866 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3867 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3868
3869 Example:
3870
3871 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3872
3873 applied to:
3874
3875 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3876
3877 outputs:
3878
3879 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3880
3881 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3882
3883 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3884 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3885 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3886 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3887 header.
3888
3889 Example:
3890
3891 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3892
3893 applied to:
3894
3895 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3896
3897 outputs:
3898
3899 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3900
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003901 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3902 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3903 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3904 it.
3905
3906 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3907 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3908 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3909 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3910 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3911 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3912
3913 Example :
3914 # prepend the host name before the path
3915 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3916
3917 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3918 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3919 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3920 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3921 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3922 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3923 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3924 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3925
3926 Example :
3927 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3928 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3929
3930 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3931 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3932 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3933 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3934 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3935 "set-query".
3936
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003937 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3938 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3939 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3940 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3941 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3942 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3943 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3944 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3945
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003946 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3947 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3948 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3949 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3950 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3951 another equipment.
3952
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003953 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3954 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3955 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3956 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3957 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3958 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3959 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3960 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3961
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003962 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3963 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3964 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3965 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3966 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3967 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3968 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3969 admin privileges.
3970
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003971 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3972 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3973 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3974 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3975 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3976 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3977 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3978 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3979
3980 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3981 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3982 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3983 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3984 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3985 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3986
3987 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3988 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3989 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3990 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3991 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3992 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3993
3994 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3995 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3996 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3997 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3998 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3999 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4000 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4001 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4002 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
4003
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004004 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004005 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
4006 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4007 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
4008 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
4009 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
4010 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
4011 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
4012 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4013 request header" for more information.
4014
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004015 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
4016 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
4017 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
4018 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004019 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4020 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004021
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004022 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4023 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
4024 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
4025 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
4026 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4027 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4028 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4029 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4030 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4031 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4032 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4033 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4034
4035 These actions take one or two arguments :
4036 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4037 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4038 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4039 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4040
4041 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4042 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4043 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4044 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4045
4046 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4047 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4048 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4049 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4050 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4051 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4052 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4053 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4054
4055 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4056 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4057 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4058 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4059 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4060
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004061 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4062 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4063 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4064 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4065 continues.
4066
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004067 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4068 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4069 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4070 the actions evaluation continues.
4071
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004072 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4073 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4074 inline.
4075
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004076 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4077 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004078 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004079 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4080 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004081 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004082 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004083 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004084 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4085 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004086 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004087 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004088 and '_'.
4089
4090 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4091 followed by some converters.
4092
4093 Example:
4094
4095 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4096
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004097 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4098 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4099
4100 Example:
4101
4102 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4103
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004104 - set-src <expr> :
4105 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4106 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4107 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4108 source IP for privacy.
4109
4110 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4111 followed by some converters.
4112
4113 Example:
4114
4115 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4116 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4117
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004118 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4119 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004120
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004121 - set-src-port <expr> :
4122 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4123 expression.
4124
4125 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4126 followed by some converters.
4127
4128 Example:
4129
4130 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4131 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4132
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004133 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4134 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4135 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004136
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004137 - set-dst <expr> :
4138 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4139 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4140 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4141 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4142 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4143
4144 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4145 followed by some converters.
4146
4147 Example:
4148
4149 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4150 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4151
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004152 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4153 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4154
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004155 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4156 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4157 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4158 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4159
4160 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4161 followed by some converters.
4162
4163 Example:
4164
4165 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4166 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4167
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004168 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4169 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4170 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4171
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004172 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4173 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4174 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4175 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4176 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4177 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4178 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4179 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4180 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4181 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4182 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4183 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4184 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4185 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4186 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4187 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4188
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004189
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004190 - "wait-for-handshake" : this will delay the processing of the request
4191 until the SSL handshake happened. This is mostly useful to delay
4192 processing early data until we're sure they are valid.
4193
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004194 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4195 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4196 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4197 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4198 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4199 SPOE agent name must be used.
4200
4201 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4202
4203 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4204 configuration.
4205
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004206 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4207
4208 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4209 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004210 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4211 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4212
4213 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4214 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4215 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4216 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004217
4218 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004219 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4220 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4221 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004222
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004223 http-request allow if nagios
4224 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4225 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4226 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004227
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004228 Example:
4229 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004230 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004231
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004232 Example:
4233 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4234 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004235 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004236 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4237 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4238 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4239 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4240 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4241 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4242
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004243 Example:
4244 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4245 acl add path /addacl
4246 acl del path /delacl
4247
4248 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4249
4250 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4251 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4252
4253 Example:
4254 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4255 acl setmap path /setmap
4256 acl delmap path /delmap
4257
4258 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4259
4260 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4261 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4262
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004263 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4264 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004265
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004266http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004267 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004268 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004269 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4270 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004271 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004272 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4273 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4274 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4275 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004276 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004277 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004278 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004279 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004280 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004281 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004282 silent-drop |
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004283 send-spoe-group
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004284 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004285 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004286 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4287
4288 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4289 no | yes | yes | yes
4290
4291 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4292 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4293 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4294 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4295 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4296 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4297
4298 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4299 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4300 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4301 current section.
4302
4303 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4304 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4305 rules are evaluated.
4306
4307 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4308 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4309 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4310 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4311 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4312 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4313 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4314
4315 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4316 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4317 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4318 external users.
4319
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004320 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4321 <name>.
4322
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004323 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4324 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4325 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4326 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4327 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4328 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4329 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4330 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4331
4332 Example:
4333
4334 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4335
4336 applied to:
4337
4338 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4339
4340 outputs:
4341
4342 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4343
4344 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4345
4346 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4347 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4348 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4349 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4350 header.
4351
4352 Example:
4353
4354 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4355
4356 applied to:
4357
4358 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4359
4360 outputs:
4361
4362 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4363
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004364 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004365 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4366 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4367 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004368
4369 Example:
4370
4371 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4372 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004373 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4374 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004375
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004376 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4377 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4378 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4379 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4380 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4381 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4382 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4383 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4384
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004385 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4386 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4387 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4388 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4389 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4390 another equipment.
4391
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004392 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4393 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4394 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4395 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4396 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4397 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4398 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4399 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4400
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004401 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4402 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4403 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4404 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4405 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4406 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4407 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4408 admin privileges.
4409
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004410 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4411 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4412 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4413 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4414 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4415 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4416 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4417 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4418
4419 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4420 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4421 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4422 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4423 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4424 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4425
4426 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4427 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4428 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4429 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4430 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4431 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4432
4433 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4434 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4435 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4436 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4437 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4438 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4439 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4440 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4441 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4442
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004443 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4444 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4445 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4446 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4447 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4448 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4449 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4450 response header" for more information.
4451
4452 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4453 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4454 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4455 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4456 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004457 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4458 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004459
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004460 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4461 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4462 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4463 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4464 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4465 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4466
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004467 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4468 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4469 inline.
4470
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004471 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4472 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004473 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004474 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4475 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004476 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004477 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004478 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004479 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4480 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004481 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004482 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4483 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004484
4485 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4486 followed by some converters.
4487
4488 Example:
4489
4490 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4491
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004492 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4493 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4494
4495 Example:
4496
4497 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4498
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004499 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4500 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4501 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4502 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4503 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4504 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4505 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4506
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004507 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4508 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4509 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4510 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4511 continues.
4512
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004513 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4514 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4515 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4516 the actions evaluation continues.
4517
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004518 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4519 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4520 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4521 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4522 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4523 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4524 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4525 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4526 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4527 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4528 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4529 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4530 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4531 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4532 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4533 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4534
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004535 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name> :
4536 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do
4537 so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the
4538 SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing
4539 SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the
4540 SPOE agent name must be used.
4541
4542 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4543
4544 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4545 configuration.
4546
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004547 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4548
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004549 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004550 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4551 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004552 rules.
4553
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004554 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4555 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4556 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4557 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4558
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004559 Example:
4560 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4561
4562 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4563
4564 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4565 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4566
4567 Example:
4568 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4569
4570 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4571
4572 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4573 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4574
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004575 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4576 ACL usage.
4577
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004578
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004579http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4580 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4581
4582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4583 yes | no | yes | yes
4584
4585 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4586 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4587 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4588 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4589 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4590 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4591
4592 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4593
4594 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4595 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4596 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4597 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4598 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4599 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4600 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4601 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4602 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4603 not checking any request past the first one.
4604
4605 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4606 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4607 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4608 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4609 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4610 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4611 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4612
4613 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4614 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4615 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4616 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4617 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4618 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4619 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4620 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4621 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4622 downsides of rare connection failures.
4623
4624 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4625 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4626 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4627 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4628 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4629 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4630 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4631 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4632 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4633 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4634 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4635 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4636
4637 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4638 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4639 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4640 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4641
4642 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4643 and are never shared ;
4644
4645 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4646 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4647 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4648 and are never shared ;
4649
4650 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4651 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4652 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4653
4654 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4655 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4656 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4657
4658 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4659
4660
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004661http-send-name-header [<header>]
4662 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4663
4664 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4665 yes | no | yes | yes
4666
4667 Arguments :
4668
4669 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4670
4671 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4672 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4673 is added with the header string proved.
4674
4675 See also : "server"
4676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004677id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004678 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4680 no | yes | yes | yes
4681 Arguments : none
4682
4683 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4684 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4685 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004686
4687
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004688ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4689 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4691 no | yes | yes | yes
4692
4693 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4694 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4695 and running).
4696
4697 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4698 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4699 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004700 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004701 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4702
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004703 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4704 "unless" condition is met.
4705
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004706 Example:
4707 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4708 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4709 ignore-persist if url_static
4710
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004711 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4712
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004713load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4714 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4715 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4716 yes | no | yes | yes
4717
4718 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4719 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4720 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4721 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4722 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4723 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4724 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4725 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4726
4727 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4728 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02004729 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004730
4731 Arguments:
4732 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4733 named "server-state-file".
4734
4735 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4736 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4737 name is used as a file name.
4738
4739 none don't load any stat for this backend
4740
4741 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004742 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4743 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4744 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4745 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4746 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004747
4748 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4749 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4750
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004751 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004752
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004753 global
4754 stats socket /tmp/socket
4755 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004756
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004757 defaults
4758 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004759
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004760 backend bk
4761 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4762 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004763
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004764
4765 Then one can run :
4766
4767 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4768
4769 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4770
4771 1
4772 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4773 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4774 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4775
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004776 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004777
4778 global
4779 stats socket /tmp/socket
4780 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4781
4782 defaults
4783 load-server-state-from-file local
4784
4785 backend bk
4786 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4787 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4788
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004789
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004790 Then one can run :
4791
4792 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4793
4794 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4795
4796 1
4797 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4798 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4799 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4800
4801 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4802 "show servers state"
4803
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004804
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004805log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004806log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004807no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004808 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4810 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004811
4812 Prefix :
4813 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4814 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4815 prefix does not allow arguments.
4816
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004817 Arguments :
4818 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4819 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4820 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4821 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4822 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4823 parameter.
4824
4825 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4826 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4827
4828 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4829 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4830 standard syslog port).
4831
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004832 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4833 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4834 standard syslog port).
4835
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004836 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4837 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4838 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4839 appropriately writeable).
4840
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004841 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4842 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004843
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004844 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4845 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4846 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4847 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4848 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4849 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4850 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4851 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4852 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4853 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4854 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4855
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004856 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4857
4858 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4859 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4860 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4861
4862 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4863 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4864 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004865 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4866 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4867 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4868 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4869 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004870
4871 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4872
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004873 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4874 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4875 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004876
4877 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4878 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4879 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4880 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4881
4882 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4883 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004884
4885 Example :
4886 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004887 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4888 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004889 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004890
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004891
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004892log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004893 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4894 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4895 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004896
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004897 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4898 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4899 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4900 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4901 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004902
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004903 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4904 "option httplog" directives.
4905
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004906log-format-sd <string>
4907 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4908 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4909 yes | yes | yes | no
4910
4911 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4912 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4913 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4914 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4915 which covers the log format string in depth.
4916
4917 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4918 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4919
4920 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4921 log format to "rfc5424".
4922
4923 Example :
4924 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4925
4926
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004927log-tag <string>
4928 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4929 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4930 yes | yes | yes | yes
4931
4932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4933 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4934 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4935 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4936 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4937 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4938 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4939 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4940 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004941
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004942max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4943 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4944 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4945 yes | no | yes | yes
4946
4947 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4948 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4949 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4950 servers.
4951
4952 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4953 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4954 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4955 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4956 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4957 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4958 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4959 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4960 picking a different server.
4961
4962 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4963 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4964 even if they have to be queued.
4965
4966 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4967 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4968
4969
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004970maxconn <conns>
4971 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4973 yes | yes | yes | no
4974 Arguments :
4975 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4976 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4977 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4978 closes.
4979
4980 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4981 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4982 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4983 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004984 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4985 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4986 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4987 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004988
4989 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4990 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4991 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4992
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004993 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4994
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004995 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4996
4997
4998mode { tcp|http|health }
4999 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 yes | yes | yes | yes
5002 Arguments :
5003 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5004 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5005 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5006 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5007
5008 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5009 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5010 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5011 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5012 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5013
5014 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005015 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5016 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5017 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5018 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5019 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5020 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5021 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005022
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005023 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5024 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5025 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005026
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005027 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005028 defaults http_instances
5029 mode http
5030
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005031 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005032
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005033
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005034monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005035 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5037 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005038 Arguments :
5039 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5040 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005041 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005042 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5043 backend and its backup.
5044
5045 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5046 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5047 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5048 servers in a list of backends.
5049
5050 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5051 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5052 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5053 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5054 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5055 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5056 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005057 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5058 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005059
5060 Example:
5061 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005062 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005063 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5064 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5065 monitor-uri /site_alive
5066 monitor fail if site_dead
5067
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005068 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005069
5070
5071monitor-net <source>
5072 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5074 yes | yes | yes | no
5075 Arguments :
5076 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5077 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5078 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5079 followed by a mask.
5080
5081 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5082 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005083 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005084 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5085
5086 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5087 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5088 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5089 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005090 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5091 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5092 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005093
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005094 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5095 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5096 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5097 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5098 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5099 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005100
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005101 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5102 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005103
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005104 Example :
5105 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5106 frontend www
5107 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5108
5109 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5110
5111
5112monitor-uri <uri>
5113 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5115 yes | yes | yes | no
5116 Arguments :
5117 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5118 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5119
5120 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5121 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5122 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5123 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5124 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5125 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5126 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5127 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5128
5129 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5130 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5131 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5132 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5133 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5134 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5135
5136 Example :
5137 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5138 frontend www
5139 mode http
5140 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5141
5142 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5143
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005144
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005145option abortonclose
5146no option abortonclose
5147 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5149 yes | no | yes | yes
5150 Arguments : none
5151
5152 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5153 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5154 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5155 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005156 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005157 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5158 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5159 encountered while delivering the response.
5160
5161 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5162 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5163 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5164 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5165 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5166 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005167 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005168 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005169 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005170 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5171 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5172 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5173
5174 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5175 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5176 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5177 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5178 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5179 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5180 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5181 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005182 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005183
5184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5186
5187 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5188
5189
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005190option accept-invalid-http-request
5191no option accept-invalid-http-request
5192 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5194 yes | yes | yes | no
5195 Arguments : none
5196
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005197 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005198 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5199 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5200 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5201 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5202 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5203 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5204 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005205 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5206 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5207 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5208 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5209 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005210 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005211 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5212 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5213 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005214
5215 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5216 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5217 been confirmed.
5218
5219 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5220 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005221 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5222 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005223 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5224
5225 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5226 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5227
5228 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5229 stats socket.
5230
5231
5232option accept-invalid-http-response
5233no option accept-invalid-http-response
5234 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5236 yes | no | yes | yes
5237 Arguments : none
5238
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005239 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005240 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5241 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5242 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5243 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5244 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5245 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5246 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005247 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5248 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5249 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005250
5251 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5252 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5253 been confirmed.
5254
5255 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5256 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5257 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5258 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5259
5260 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5261 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5262
5263 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5264 stats socket.
5265
5266
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005267option allbackups
5268no option allbackups
5269 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5271 yes | no | yes | yes
5272 Arguments : none
5273
5274 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5275 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5276 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5277 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5278 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5279 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5280 order between the backup servers anymore.
5281
5282 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5283 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5284
5285 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5286 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5287
5288
5289option checkcache
5290no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005291 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5293 yes | no | yes | yes
5294 Arguments : none
5295
5296 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5297 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005298 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005299 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5300 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005301 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005302
5303 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005304 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005305 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005306 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5307 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005308 to the client are :
5309 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005310 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005311 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005312 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5313 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5314 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5315 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5316 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5317 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5318 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5319 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5320 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5321 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5322 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5323
5324 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005325 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005326 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005327 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005328 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5329
5330 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5331 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005332 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005333 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5334
5335 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5336 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5337
5338
5339option clitcpka
5340no option clitcpka
5341 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5343 yes | yes | yes | no
5344 Arguments : none
5345
5346 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5347 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5348 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5349 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5350
5351 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5352 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5353 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5354 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5355
5356 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5357 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5358 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5359 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5360 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5361
5362 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5363
5364 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5365 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5366 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5367
5368 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5369 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5370
5371 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5372
5373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005374option contstats
5375 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5377 yes | yes | yes | no
5378 Arguments : none
5379
5380 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5381 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5382 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5383 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005384 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5385 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5386 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5387 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5388 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005389
5390
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005391option dontlog-normal
5392no option dontlog-normal
5393 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5395 yes | yes | yes | no
5396 Arguments : none
5397
5398 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5399 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5400 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5401 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5402 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5403 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5404 logged.
5405
5406 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5407 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5408 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005410 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005411 logging.
5412
5413
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005414option dontlognull
5415no option dontlognull
5416 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5418 yes | yes | yes | no
5419 Arguments : none
5420
5421 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5422 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5423 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5424 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5425 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5426 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005427 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5428 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5429 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005430
5431 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5432 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5433 would not be logged.
5434
5435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5437
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005438 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5439 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005440
5441
5442option forceclose
5443no option forceclose
5444 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005446 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005447 Arguments : none
5448
5449 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5450 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5451 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5452 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5453 global session times in the logs.
5454
5455 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005456 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005457 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005458
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005459 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5460 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5461 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5462
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005463 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5464 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005465
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005466 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5467 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5468
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005469 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005470
5471
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005472option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005473 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5475 yes | yes | yes | yes
5476 Arguments :
5477 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5478 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005479 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005480 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005481
5482 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5483 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5484 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5485 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5486 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5487 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5488 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005489 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5490 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5491 possible that the client has already brought one.
5492
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005493 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005494 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005495 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5496 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005497 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5498 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005499
5500 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5501 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5502 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5503 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5504 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5505 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5506 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5507
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005508 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5509 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5510 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5511 are under the control of the end-user.
5512
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005513 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005514 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5515 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005516 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5517 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5518 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005519
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005520 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005521 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5522 frontend www
5523 mode http
5524 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5525
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005526 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5527 backend www
5528 mode http
5529 option forwardfor header X-Client
5530
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005531 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005532 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005533
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005534
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005535option http-buffer-request
5536no option http-buffer-request
5537 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 yes | yes | yes | yes
5540 Arguments : none
5541
5542 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5543 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5544 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5545 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5546 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5547 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5548 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5549 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005550 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005551 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5552 default.
5553
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005554 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005555
5556
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005557option http-ignore-probes
5558no option http-ignore-probes
5559 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5561 yes | yes | yes | no
5562 Arguments : none
5563
5564 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5565 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5566 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5567 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5568 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5569 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5570 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5571 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5572 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5573 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5574 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5575 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5576
5577 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5578 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5579 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5580 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5581 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5582 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5583 are often the only way to detect them.
5584
5585 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5586 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5587
5588 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5589
5590
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005591option http-keep-alive
5592no option http-keep-alive
5593 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5594 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5595 yes | yes | yes | yes
5596 Arguments : none
5597
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005598 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5599 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5600 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5601 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5602 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5603 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5604 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5605
5606 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5607 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005608 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5609 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5610 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5611 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5612 situations where this option may be useful :
5613
5614 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5615 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5616
5617 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5618 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5619
5620 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5621 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5622 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5623 request.
5624
5625 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5626 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005627 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5628 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5629 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005630
5631 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5632 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5633
5634 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5635 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5636 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5637 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5638 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5639 not set.
5640
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005641 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5642 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005643 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005644 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005645
5646 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005647 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5648 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005649
5650
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005651option http-no-delay
5652no option http-no-delay
5653 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5655 yes | yes | yes | yes
5656 Arguments : none
5657
5658 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5659 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5660 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5661 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5662 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5663 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5664 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5665 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5666 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5667 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5668 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5669 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5670 affected.
5671
5672 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5673 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5674 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5675 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5676 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5677 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5678 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5679 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5680 latency environments.
5681
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005682 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5683
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005684
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005685option http-pretend-keepalive
5686no option http-pretend-keepalive
5687 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5689 yes | yes | yes | yes
5690 Arguments : none
5691
5692 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5693 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5694 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5695 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5696 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5697 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5698 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5699 consider the response complete.
5700
5701 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5702 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5703 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5704 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5705 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5706 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5707
5708 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5709 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5710 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5711 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5712 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5713 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5714 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5715
5716 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5717 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005718 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005719 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5720 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005721
5722 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5723 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5724
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005725 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5726 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005727
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005728
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005729option http-server-close
5730no option http-server-close
5731 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5733 yes | yes | yes | yes
5734 Arguments : none
5735
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005736 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5737 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5738 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5739 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5740 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5741 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5742 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5743 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5744 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5745 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5746 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005747 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005748 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5749 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5750 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5751 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005752
5753 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5754 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5755 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5756 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005757 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5758 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005759
5760 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5761 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005762 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5763 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005764 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5765 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005766
5767 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5768 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5769
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005770 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005771 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5772 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005773
5774
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005775option http-tunnel
5776no option http-tunnel
5777 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5779 yes | yes | yes | yes
5780 Arguments : none
5781
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005782 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5783 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5784 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5785 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5786 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5787 "option http-tunnel".
5788
5789 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005790 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005791 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5792 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5793 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5794 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5795 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5796 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5797 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005798
5799 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5800 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5801
5802 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5803 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5804 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5805
5806
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005807option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005808no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005809 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5811 yes | yes | yes | no
5812 Arguments : none
5813
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005814 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005815 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5816 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5817 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5818 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5819 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5820 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5821
5822 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5823 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005824 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5825 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5826 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005827
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005828 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5829 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5830 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5831 front of an existing proxy.
5832
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005833 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5834
5835 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5836 http-server-close".
5837
5838
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005839option httpchk
5840option httpchk <uri>
5841option httpchk <method> <uri>
5842option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5843 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5845 yes | no | yes | yes
5846 Arguments :
5847 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5848 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5849 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5850 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5851 ones.
5852
5853 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5854 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5855 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5856
5857 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5858 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5859 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5860 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5861 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5862
5863 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5864 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5865 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5866 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5867 the lack of any response.
5868
5869 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5870
5871 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5872 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5873 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5874
5875 Examples :
5876 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5877 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5878 backend https_relay
5879 mode tcp
5880 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5881 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5882
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005883 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5884 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5885 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005886
5887
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005888option httpclose
5889no option httpclose
5890 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5892 yes | yes | yes | yes
5893 Arguments : none
5894
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005895 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5896 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5897 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5898 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005899 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005900 "option http-tunnel".
5901
5902 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5903 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5904 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5905 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5906 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5907 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5908 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5909 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005910
5911 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005912 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005913 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5914 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5915 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5916 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5917 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005918
5919 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5920 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005921 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5922 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005923 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5924 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005925
5926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5928
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005929 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5930 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005931
5932
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005933option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005934 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5935 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5936 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005937 Arguments :
5938 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5939 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5940 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5941 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5942 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005943
5944 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5945 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5946 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5947 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5948 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5949 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5950 ports.
5951
5952 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5953
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005954 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5955 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005956
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005957 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005959 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005960
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005961
5962option http_proxy
5963no option http_proxy
5964 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5966 yes | yes | yes | yes
5967 Arguments : none
5968
5969 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5970 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5971 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5972 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5973 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5974
5975 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5976 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005977 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5978 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005979
5980 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5981 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5982
5983 Example :
5984 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5985 backend direct_forward
5986 option httpclose
5987 option http_proxy
5988
5989 See also : "option httpclose"
5990
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005991
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005992option independent-streams
5993no option independent-streams
5994 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5996 yes | yes | yes | yes
5997 Arguments : none
5998
5999 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6000 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6001 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6002 receive data or not.
6003
6004 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
6005 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6006 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6007 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6008 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6009 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6010 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6011 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6012 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6013 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6014 socket buffers.
6015
6016 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6017 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6018 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6019 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6020 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6021
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006022 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006023 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6024 deprecated.
6025
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006026 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006027
6028
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006029option ldap-check
6030 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6032 yes | no | yes | yes
6033 Arguments : none
6034
6035 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6036 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6037 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6038 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6039
6040 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6041 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6042
6043 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6044 configure it.
6045
6046 Example :
6047 option ldap-check
6048
6049 See also : "option httpchk"
6050
6051
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006052option external-check
6053 Use external processes for server health checks
6054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6055 yes | no | yes | yes
6056
6057 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6058 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6059 command".
6060
6061 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6062
6063 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6064
6065
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006066option log-health-checks
6067no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006068 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6070 yes | no | yes | yes
6071 Arguments : none
6072
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006073 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6074 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6075 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006076
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006077 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6078 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6079 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6080 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6081 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6082
6083 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6084 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006085
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006086 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6087 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6088 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006089
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006090
6091option log-separate-errors
6092no option log-separate-errors
6093 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6095 yes | yes | yes | no
6096 Arguments : none
6097
6098 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6099 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6100 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6101 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6102 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6103 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6104 provides very important information.
6105
6106 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6107 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6108 error logs.
6109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006110 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006111 logging.
6112
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006113
6114option logasap
6115no option logasap
6116 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6118 yes | yes | yes | no
6119 Arguments : none
6120
6121 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6122 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6123 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6124 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6125 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6126 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6127 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006128 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006129 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6130 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6131
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006132 Examples :
6133 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6134 mode http
6135 option httplog
6136 option logasap
6137 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6138
6139 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6140 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6141 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6142 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6143
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006144 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006145 logging.
6146
6147
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006148option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006149 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006150 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6151 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006152 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006153 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6154 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006155 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006156
6157 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6158 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6159 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6160 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6161 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6162 in the MySQL table, like this :
6163
6164 USE mysql;
6165 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6166 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6167
6168 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6169 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6170 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6171 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6172 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6173 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6174 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6175 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6176 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6177
6178 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6179 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006180
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006181 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006182
6183 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6184 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6185 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6186 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006187 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6188 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006189
6190 See also: "option httpchk"
6191
6192
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006193option nolinger
6194no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006195 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006196 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6197 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006198 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006199
6200 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6201 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6202 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6203 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6204 connections.
6205
6206 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6207 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6208 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6209 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6210 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6211 this too.
6212
6213 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6214 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6215 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6216
6217 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6218 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6219 for servers.
6220
6221 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6222 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6223
6224
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006225option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6226 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6228 yes | yes | yes | yes
6229 Arguments :
6230 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6231 matching <network>
6232 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6233 header name.
6234
6235 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6236 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6237 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6238 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6239 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6240 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6241 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6242 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6243 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6244 possible that the client has already brought one.
6245
6246 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6247 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6248 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6249 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6250 header and requires different one.
6251
6252 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6253 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6254 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6255 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6256 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6257 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6258 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6259
6260 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6261 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6262 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6263 both are defined.
6264
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006265 Examples :
6266 # Original Destination address
6267 frontend www
6268 mode http
6269 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6270
6271 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6272 backend www
6273 mode http
6274 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6275
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006276 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6277 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006278
6279
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006280option persist
6281no option persist
6282 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6284 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006285 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006286
6287 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6288 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6289 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6290 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6291 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6292 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6293 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6294 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6295 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6296 redirected to another valid server.
6297
6298 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6299 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6300
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006301 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006302
6303
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006304option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6305 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6307 yes | no | yes | yes
6308 Arguments :
6309 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6310 PostgreSQL server.
6311
6312 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6313 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6314 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6315 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6316
6317 See also: "option httpchk"
6318
6319
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006320option prefer-last-server
6321no option prefer-last-server
6322 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6323 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6324 yes | no | yes | yes
6325 Arguments : none
6326
6327 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6328 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6329 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6330 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6331 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6332 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6333 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6334 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6335 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006336 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6337 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6338 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6339 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6340 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6341 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6342 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006343
6344 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6345 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6346
6347 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6348
6349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006350option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006351option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006352no option redispatch
6353 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6354 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6355 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006356 Arguments :
6357 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6358 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6359 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6360 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6361 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6362 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6363 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6364 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6365 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6366
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006367
6368 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6369 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6370 be able to access the service anymore.
6371
6372 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6373 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6374
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006375 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006376 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6377 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006378
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006379 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6380 "redisp" keywords.
6381
6382 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6383 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6384
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006385 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006386
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006387
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006388option redis-check
6389 Use redis health checks for server testing
6390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6391 yes | no | yes | yes
6392 Arguments : none
6393
6394 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6395 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6396 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6397 find the "+PONG" response message.
6398
6399 Example :
6400 option redis-check
6401
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006402 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006403
6404
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006405option smtpchk
6406option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6407 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6409 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006410 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006411 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6412 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6413 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6414
6415 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6416 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6417 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6418
6419 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6420 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6421 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6422 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6423 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6424 dead server.
6425
6426 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6427 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6428 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6429 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6430
6431 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6432 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6433 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6434 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006435 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006436
6437 Example :
6438 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6439
6440 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6441
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006442
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006443option socket-stats
6444no option socket-stats
6445
6446 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6448 yes | yes | yes | no
6449
6450 Arguments : none
6451
6452
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006453option splice-auto
6454no option splice-auto
6455 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6457 yes | yes | yes | yes
6458 Arguments : none
6459
6460 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6461 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6462 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6463 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006464 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006465 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6466 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6467 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6468 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6469
6470 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6471 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6472 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6473 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6474 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6475 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6476 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6477 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6478 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6479 keyword.
6480
6481 Example :
6482 option splice-auto
6483
6484 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6485 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6486
6487 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6488 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6489
6490
6491option splice-request
6492no option splice-request
6493 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6495 yes | yes | yes | yes
6496 Arguments : none
6497
6498 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006499 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006500 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6501 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6502 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6503 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6504
6505 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6506
6507 Example :
6508 option splice-request
6509
6510 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6511 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6512
6513 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6514 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6515
6516
6517option splice-response
6518no option splice-response
6519 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6521 yes | yes | yes | yes
6522 Arguments : none
6523
6524 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006525 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006526 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6527 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6528 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6529 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6530
6531 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6532
6533 Example :
6534 option splice-response
6535
6536 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6537 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6538
6539 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6540 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6541
6542
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006543option spop-check
6544 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6546 no | no | no | yes
6547 Arguments : none
6548
6549 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6550 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6551 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6552 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6553
6554 Example :
6555 option spop-check
6556
6557 See also : "option httpchk"
6558
6559
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006560option srvtcpka
6561no option srvtcpka
6562 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6563 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6564 yes | no | yes | yes
6565 Arguments : none
6566
6567 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6568 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6569 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6570 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6571
6572 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6573 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6574 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6575 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6576
6577 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6578 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6579 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6580 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6581 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6582
6583 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6584
6585 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6586 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6587 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6588
6589 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6590 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6591
6592 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6593
6594
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006595option ssl-hello-chk
6596 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6598 yes | no | yes | yes
6599 Arguments : none
6600
6601 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6602 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6603 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6604 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6605 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6606 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6607 hello message.
6608
6609 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6610 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6611 messages, which is appreciable.
6612
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006613 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6614 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6615 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006616
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006617 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6618
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006619
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006620option tcp-check
6621 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6622 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6623 yes | no | yes | yes
6624
6625 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6626 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6627
6628 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6629 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6630 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6631
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006632 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006633 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6634 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6635 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6636 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6637 only.
6638
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006639 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006640 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6641 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6642 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6643 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6644
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006645 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006646 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6647 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006648 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006649 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6650 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6651 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6652 the respective protocols.
6653 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6654 analysed.
6655
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006656 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6657 script.
6658
6659 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6660 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6661 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6662 The "comment" is of course optional.
6663
6664
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006665 Examples :
6666 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6667 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006668 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006669
6670 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6671 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006672 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006673
6674 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6675 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006676 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006677 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006678 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006679 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006680 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006681 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006682 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6683 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006684 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006685 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6686 tcp-check expect string +OK
6687
6688 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6689 (send many headers before analyzing)
6690 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006691 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006692 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6693 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6694 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6695 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006696 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006697
6698
6699 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6700
6701
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006702option tcp-smart-accept
6703no option tcp-smart-accept
6704 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6706 yes | yes | yes | no
6707 Arguments : none
6708
6709 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6710 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6711 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6712 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6713 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6714 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6715
6716 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6717 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6718 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6719 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6720
6721 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6722 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6723 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6724 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6725
6726 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6727 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6728 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6729
6730 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6731 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6732 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6733
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006734 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6735
6736
6737option tcp-smart-connect
6738no option tcp-smart-connect
6739 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6741 yes | no | yes | yes
6742 Arguments : none
6743
6744 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6745 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6746 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6747 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6748 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6749
6750 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6751 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6752 complex.
6753
6754 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6755 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6756 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6757
6758 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6759 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6760
6761 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6762
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006763
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006764option tcpka
6765 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6767 yes | yes | yes | yes
6768 Arguments : none
6769
6770 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6771 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6772 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6773 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6774
6775 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6776 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6777 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6778 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6779
6780 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6781 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6782 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6783 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6784 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6785
6786 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6787
6788 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6789 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6790 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6791 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6792 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6793 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6794 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6795 backends.
6796
6797 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6798
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006799
6800option tcplog
6801 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6803 yes | yes | yes | yes
6804 Arguments : none
6805
6806 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6807 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6808 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6809 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6810 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6811 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6812 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6813 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6814
6815 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6816
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006817 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6818
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006819 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006820
6821
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006822option transparent
6823no option transparent
6824 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6825 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006826 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006827 Arguments : none
6828
6829 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6830 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6831 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6832 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6833 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6834 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6835 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6836 appropriate server.
6837
6838 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6839 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6840
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006841 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006842 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006843
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006844
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006845external-check command <command>
6846 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6848 yes | no | yes | yes
6849
6850 Arguments :
6851 <command> is the external command to run
6852
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006853 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6854
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006855 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006856
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006857 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6858 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6859 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6860 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6861 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6862 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006863
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006864 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6865
6866 Environment variables :
6867 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6868 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6869
6870 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6871
6872 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6873
6874 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6875 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6876 for a UNIX socket).
6877
6878 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6879
6880 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6881
6882 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6883
6884 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6885
6886 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6887
6888 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6889 socket).
6890
6891 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6892 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6893
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006894 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6895 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6896 failed.
6897
6898 Example :
6899 external-check command /bin/true
6900
6901 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6902
6903
6904external-check path <path>
6905 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6907 yes | no | yes | yes
6908
6909 Arguments :
6910 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6911
6912 The default path is "".
6913
6914 Example :
6915 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6916
6917 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6918 "external-check command"
6919
6920
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006921persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006922persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006923 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6925 yes | no | yes | yes
6926 Arguments :
6927 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006928 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6929 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006930
6931 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6932 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6933 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6934 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6935 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6936 forwarded to this server.
6937
6938 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6939 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6940 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006941 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006942 a single "listen" section.
6943
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006944 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6945 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6946 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6947
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006948 Example :
6949 listen tse-farm
6950 bind :3389
6951 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6952 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6953 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6954 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6955 persist rdp-cookie
6956 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006957 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006958 balance rdp-cookie
6959 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6960 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6961
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006962 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6963 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006964
6965
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006966rate-limit sessions <rate>
6967 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6969 yes | yes | yes | no
6970 Arguments :
6971 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6972 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6973
6974 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6975 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6976 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6977 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6978 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6979 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6980
6981 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6982 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6983 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6984 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6985
6986 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6987 listen smtp
6988 mode tcp
6989 bind :25
6990 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006991 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006992
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006993 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6994 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6995 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006996
6997 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6998
6999
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007000redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7001redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7002redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007003 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7005 no | yes | yes | yes
7006
7007 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007008 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007009
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007010 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007011 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007012 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7013 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7014 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007015
7016 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7017 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7018 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7019 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7020 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007021 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7022 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7023 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7024 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007025
7026 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7027 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7028 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7029 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7030 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7031 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007032 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007033 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007034 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7035 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7036 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007037
7038 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007039 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7040 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7041 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007042 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007043 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7044 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7045 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7046 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007047
7048 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
7049 expected behaviour of a redirection :
7050
7051 - "drop-query"
7052 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7053 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7054 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7055 with a location-type redirect.
7056
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007057 - "append-slash"
7058 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7059 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7060 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7061 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7062
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007063 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7064 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7065 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7066 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7067 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7068 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7069 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7070
7071 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7072 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7073 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7074 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7075 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7076 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7077 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007078
7079 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7080 acl clear dst_port 80
7081 acl secure dst_port 8080
7082 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007083 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007084 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007085 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7086
7087 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007088 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7089 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7090 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007091 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007092
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007093 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7094 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7095 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7096
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007097 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007098 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007099
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007100 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007101 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7102 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7103 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007105 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007106
7107
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007108redisp (deprecated)
7109redispatch (deprecated)
7110 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7111 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7112 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007113 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007114
7115 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7116 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7117 be able to access the service anymore.
7118
7119 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7120 redistribute them to a working server.
7121
7122 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7123 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7124 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007125
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007126 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7127 "option redispatch" instead.
7128
7129 See also : "option redispatch"
7130
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007131
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007132reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007133 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7135 no | yes | yes | yes
7136 Arguments :
7137 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7138 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007139 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007140
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007141 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7142 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7143
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007144 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7145 the last header of an HTTP request.
7146
7147 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7148 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7149 responses.
7150
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007151 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7152 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7153 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7154
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007155 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7156 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007157
7158
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007159reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7160reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007161 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7163 no | yes | yes | yes
7164 Arguments :
7165 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7166 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7167 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7168 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7169 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7170 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7171 ignores case.
7172
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007173 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7174 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7175
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007176 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7177 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7178 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7179 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007180 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007181
7182 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7183 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7184
7185 Example :
7186 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7187 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7188 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7189
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007190 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7191 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007192
7193
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007194reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7195reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007196 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7198 no | yes | yes | yes
7199 Arguments :
7200 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7201 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7202 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7203 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7204 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7205 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7206
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007207 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7208 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7209
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007210 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7211 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7212 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7213 next servers.
7214
7215 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7216 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7217 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7218
7219 Example :
7220 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7221 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7222 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7223
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007224 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7225 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007226
7227
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007228reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7229reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007230 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 no | yes | yes | yes
7233 Arguments :
7234 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7235 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7236 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7237 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7238 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7239 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7240 case.
7241
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007242 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7243 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7244
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007245 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7246 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7247 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7248 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007249 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007250
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007251 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007252 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007253 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007254
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007255 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7256 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7257
7258 Example :
7259 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7260 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7261 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7262
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007263 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7264 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007265
7266
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007267reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7268reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007269 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7271 no | yes | yes | yes
7272 Arguments :
7273 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7274 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7275 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7276 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7277 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7278 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7279 case.
7280
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007281 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7282 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7283
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007284 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7285 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7286 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7287 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7288
7289 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7290 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7291
7292 Example :
7293 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7294 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7295 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7296 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7297
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007298 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7299 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007300
7301
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007302reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7303reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007304 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7306 no | yes | yes | yes
7307 Arguments :
7308 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7309 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7310 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7311 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7312 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7313 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7314
7315 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7316 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7317 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7318 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007319 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007320
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007321 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7322 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7323
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007324 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7325 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7326 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7327
7328 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7329 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7330 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7331 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7332 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7333
7334 Example :
7335 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007336 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007337 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7338 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7339
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007340 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7341 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007342
7343
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007344reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7345reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007346 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7348 no | yes | yes | yes
7349 Arguments :
7350 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7351 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7352 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7353 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7354 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7355 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7356 ignores case.
7357
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007358 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7359 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7360
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007361 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7362 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007363 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7364 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7365 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007366 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7367 not set.
7368
7369 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7370 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7371 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7372 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7373 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7374
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007375 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007376 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7377 # block all others.
7378 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7379 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7380
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007381 # block bad guys
7382 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7383 reqitarpit . if badguys
7384
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007385 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7386 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007387
7388
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007389retries <value>
7390 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7391 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7392 yes | no | yes | yes
7393 Arguments :
7394 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7395 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7396 default value is 3.
7397
7398 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7399 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7400 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7401
7402 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007403 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7404 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007405
7406 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7407 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7408
7409 See also : "option redispatch"
7410
7411
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007412rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007413 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7415 no | yes | yes | yes
7416 Arguments :
7417 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7418 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007419 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007420
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007421 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7422 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7423
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007424 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7425 the last header of an HTTP response.
7426
7427 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7428 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7429 responses.
7430
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007431 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7432 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007433
7434
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007435rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7436rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007437 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7439 no | yes | yes | yes
7440 Arguments :
7441 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7442 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7443 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7444 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7445 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7446 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7447 ignores case.
7448
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007449 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7450 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7451
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007452 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7453 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007454 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007455 client.
7456
7457 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7458 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7459 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7460
7461 Example :
7462 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007463 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007464
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007465 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7466 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007467
7468
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007469rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7470rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007471 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7473 no | yes | yes | yes
7474 Arguments :
7475 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7476 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7477 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7478 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7479 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7480 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7481 ignores case.
7482
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007483 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7484 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7485
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007486 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7487 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7488 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7489 case-sensitive.
7490
7491 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007492 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7493 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7494 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007495
7496 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7497 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7498
7499 Example :
7500 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7501 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7502
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007503 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7504 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007505
7506
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007507rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7508rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007509 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7511 no | yes | yes | yes
7512 Arguments :
7513 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7514 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7515 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7516 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7517 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7518 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7519 ignores case.
7520
7521 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7522 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7523 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7524 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007525 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007526
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007527 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7528 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7529
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007530 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7531 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7532 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7533
7534 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7535 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7536 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7537 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7538 are not case-sensitive.
7539
7540 Example :
7541 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7542 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7543
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007544 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7545 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007546
7547
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007548server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007549 Declare a server in a backend
7550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 no | no | yes | yes
7552 Arguments :
7553 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007554 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007555 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007556
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007557 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7558 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7559 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7560 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007561 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7562 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7563 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7564 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7565 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007566 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7567 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7568 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7569 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7570 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7571 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7572 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007573 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007574 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7575 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007576 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7577 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007578
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007579 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007580 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7581 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7582 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7583 adding this value to the client's port.
7584
7585 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7586 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007587 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007588
7589 Examples :
7590 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7591 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007592 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007593 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7594 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7595 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007596
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007597 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7598 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7599 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7600 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7601 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7602
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007603 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7604 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007605
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007606server-state-file-name [<file>]
7607 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7608 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7609 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7610 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7611 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7612 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7613
7614 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7615 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7616
7617 global
7618 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7619
7620 backend bk
7621 load-server-state-from-file
7622
7623 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7624 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007625
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007626server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7627 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7628 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7630 no | no | yes | yes
7631
7632 Arguments:
7633 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7634
7635 <num | range>
7636 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7637 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7638 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7639 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7640
7641 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7642
7643 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7644
7645 <params*>
7646 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7647 keyword.
7648
7649 Examples:
7650 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7651 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7652 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7653
7654 # or
7655 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7656
7657 # would be equivalent to:
7658 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7659 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7660 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7661
7662
7663
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007664source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007665source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007666source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007667 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7669 yes | no | yes | yes
7670 Arguments :
7671 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7672 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007673
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007674 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007675 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7676 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7677 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7678 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7679 supported prefixes are :
7680 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7681 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7682 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007683 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007684 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7685 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007686
7687 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7688 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007689 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7690 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7691 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007692
7693 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7694 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7695 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7696 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7697 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7698 <addr>.
7699
7700 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7701 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7702 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7703 port.
7704
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007705 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7706 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7707 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7708 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007709 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007710 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7711 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7712 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7713 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7714 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7715 HTTP header.
7716
7717 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7718 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007719 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007720 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7721 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7722 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7723 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7724 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7725 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7726 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7727
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007728 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7729 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7730 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7731 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7732 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7733 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7734
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007735 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7736 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7737 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7738 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7739
7740 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7741 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7742 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7743 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7744 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7745 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7746
7747 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7748 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7749 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7750 there are two methods :
7751
7752 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7753 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7754 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7755 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7756 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7757 of the client ranges may be used.
7758
7759 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7760 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7761 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7762 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7763 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7764 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7765 same session.
7766
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007767 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7768 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7769 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007770 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007771
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007772 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7773
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007774 Examples :
7775 backend private
7776 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7777 source 192.168.1.200
7778
7779 backend transparent_ssl1
7780 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7781 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7782
7783 backend transparent_ssl2
7784 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7785 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7786 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7787
7788 backend transparent_ssl3
7789 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7790 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7791 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7792
7793 backend transparent_smtp
7794 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7795 # with Tproxy version 4.
7796 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7797
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007798 backend transparent_http
7799 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7800 # proxy.
7801 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007803 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007804 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7805
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007806
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007807srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7808 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7809 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7810 yes | no | yes | yes
7811 Arguments :
7812 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7813 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7814 as explained at the top of this document.
7815
7816 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7817 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7818 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7819 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7820 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7821 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7822 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7823
7824 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7825 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7826 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7827 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7828 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007829 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007830 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007831 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007832
7833 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7834 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7835 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7836 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7837 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7838 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7839
7840 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7841 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7842
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007843 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7844 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007845
7846
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007847stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7848 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007850 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007851
7852 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7853 matched.
7854
7855 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7856 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7857
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007858 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7859 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7860 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7861
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007862 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7863 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7864 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7865 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007866
7867 Example :
7868 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7869 backend stats_localhost
7870 stats enable
7871 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7872
7873 Example :
7874 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7875 backend stats_auth
7876 stats enable
7877 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7878 stats admin if TRUE
7879
7880 Example :
7881 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7882 userlist stats-auth
7883 group admin users admin
7884 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7885 group readonly users haproxy
7886 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7887
7888 backend stats_auth
7889 stats enable
7890 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7891 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7892 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7893 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7894
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007895 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7896 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7897 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007898
7899
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007900stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7901 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007903 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007904 Arguments :
7905 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7906
7907 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7908
7909 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7910 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7911 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7912 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7913 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7914 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7915
7916 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7917 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7918 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007919 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007920
7921 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7922 report using "stats scope".
7923
7924 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7925 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7926 unobvious parameters.
7927
7928 Example :
7929 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7930 backend public_www
7931 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7932 stats enable
7933 stats hide-version
7934 stats scope .
7935 stats uri /admin?stats
7936 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7937 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7938 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7939
7940 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7941 backend private_monitoring
7942 stats enable
7943 stats uri /admin?stats
7944 stats refresh 5s
7945
7946 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7947
7948
7949stats enable
7950 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007952 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007953 Arguments : none
7954
7955 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7956 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7957 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7958 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7959 - stats auth : no authentication
7960 - stats scope : no restriction
7961
7962 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7963 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7964 unobvious parameters.
7965
7966 Example :
7967 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7968 backend public_www
7969 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7970 stats enable
7971 stats hide-version
7972 stats scope .
7973 stats uri /admin?stats
7974 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7975 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7976 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7977
7978 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7979 backend private_monitoring
7980 stats enable
7981 stats uri /admin?stats
7982 stats refresh 5s
7983
7984 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7985
7986
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007987stats hide-version
7988 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007990 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007991 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007992
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007993 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7994 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7995 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7996 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7997 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7998 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008000 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8001 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8002 unobvious parameters.
8003
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008004 Example :
8005 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8006 backend public_www
8007 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008008 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008009 stats hide-version
8010 stats scope .
8011 stats uri /admin?stats
8012 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8013 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8014 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008015
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008016 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8017 backend private_monitoring
8018 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008019 stats uri /admin?stats
8020 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008021
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008022 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008023
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008024
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008025stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8026 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8027 Access control for statistics
8028
8029 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8030 no | no | yes | yes
8031
8032 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8033 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8034 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8035 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8036 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8037 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8038
8039 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8040 instance.
8041
8042 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8043 about ACL usage.
8044
8045
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008046stats realm <realm>
8047 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008049 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008050 Arguments :
8051 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8052 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8053 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8054
8055 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8056 using a backslash ('\').
8057
8058 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8059 only related to authentication.
8060
8061 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8062 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8063 unobvious parameters.
8064
8065 Example :
8066 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8067 backend public_www
8068 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8069 stats enable
8070 stats hide-version
8071 stats scope .
8072 stats uri /admin?stats
8073 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8074 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8075 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8076
8077 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8078 backend private_monitoring
8079 stats enable
8080 stats uri /admin?stats
8081 stats refresh 5s
8082
8083 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8084
8085
8086stats refresh <delay>
8087 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008089 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008090 Arguments :
8091 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8092 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8093 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8094 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8095 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8096 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8097
8098 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8099 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8100 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8101 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8102
8103 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8104 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8105 unobvious parameters.
8106
8107 Example :
8108 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8109 backend public_www
8110 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8111 stats enable
8112 stats hide-version
8113 stats scope .
8114 stats uri /admin?stats
8115 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8116 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8117 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8118
8119 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8120 backend private_monitoring
8121 stats enable
8122 stats uri /admin?stats
8123 stats refresh 5s
8124
8125 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8126
8127
8128stats scope { <name> | "." }
8129 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008131 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008132 Arguments :
8133 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8134 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8135 section in which the statement appears.
8136
8137 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8138 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8139 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8140 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8141 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8142 exists.
8143
8144 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8145 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8146 unobvious parameters.
8147
8148 Example :
8149 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8150 backend public_www
8151 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8152 stats enable
8153 stats hide-version
8154 stats scope .
8155 stats uri /admin?stats
8156 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8157 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8158 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8159
8160 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8161 backend private_monitoring
8162 stats enable
8163 stats uri /admin?stats
8164 stats refresh 5s
8165
8166 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8167
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008168
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008169stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008170 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008172 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008173
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008174 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008175 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8176
8177 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8178 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8179
8180 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8181 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008182 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008183
8184 Example :
8185 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8186 backend private_monitoring
8187 stats enable
8188 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8189 stats uri /admin?stats
8190 stats refresh 5s
8191
8192 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8193 global section.
8194
8195
8196stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008197 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8199 yes | yes | yes | yes
8200 Arguments : none
8201
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008202 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008203 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8204 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8205 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8206 - IP (socket, server)
8207 - cookie (backend, server)
8208
8209 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8210 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008211 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008212
8213 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8214
8215
8216stats show-node [ <name> ]
8217 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008219 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008220 Arguments:
8221 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8222 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8223
8224 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8225 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008226 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008227
8228 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8229 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8230 unobvious parameters.
8231
8232 Example:
8233 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8234 backend private_monitoring
8235 stats enable
8236 stats show-node Europe-1
8237 stats uri /admin?stats
8238 stats refresh 5s
8239
8240 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8241 section.
8242
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008243
8244stats uri <prefix>
8245 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008247 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008248 Arguments :
8249 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8250 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8251 query string.
8252
8253 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8254 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8255 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8256 possible to reach it in the application.
8257
8258 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008259 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008260 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8261 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8262 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8263 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8264
8265 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8266 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8267 an address or a port to statistics only.
8268
8269 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8270 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8271 unobvious parameters.
8272
8273 Example :
8274 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8275 backend public_www
8276 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8277 stats enable
8278 stats hide-version
8279 stats scope .
8280 stats uri /admin?stats
8281 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8282 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8283 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8284
8285 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8286 backend private_monitoring
8287 stats enable
8288 stats uri /admin?stats
8289 stats refresh 5s
8290
8291 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8292
8293
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008294stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8295 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008297 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008298
8299 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008300 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008301 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8302 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8303 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8304
8305 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8306 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8307 the "stick-table" statement.
8308
8309 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8310 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8311 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8312 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8313 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8314
8315 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8316 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8317 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8318 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8319 transformation rules.
8320
8321 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8322 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8323 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8324 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8325 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8326 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8327 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8328
8329 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8330 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8331 ACL based conditions.
8332
8333 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8334 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8335 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8336 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8337
8338 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8339 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8340 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8341 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8342
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008343 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8344 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8345 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8346
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008347 Example :
8348 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8349 # last 30 minutes
8350 backend pop
8351 mode tcp
8352 balance roundrobin
8353 stick store-request src
8354 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8355 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8356 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8357
8358 backend smtp
8359 mode tcp
8360 balance roundrobin
8361 stick match src table pop
8362 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8363 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8364
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008365 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008366 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008367
8368
8369stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8370 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8372 no | no | yes | yes
8373
8374 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8375 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8376 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8377 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8378
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008379 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8380 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8381 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8382
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008383 Examples :
8384 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008385 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008386
8387 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8388 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8389 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8390
8391
8392 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8393 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8394 backend http
8395 mode http
8396 balance roundrobin
8397 stick on src table https
8398 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8399 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8400 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8401
8402 backend https
8403 mode tcp
8404 balance roundrobin
8405 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8406 stick on src
8407 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8408 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8409
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008410 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008411
8412
8413stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8414 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8416 no | no | yes | yes
8417
8418 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008419 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008420 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8421 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8422 server is selected.
8423
8424 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8425 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8426 the "stick-table" statement.
8427
8428 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8429 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8430 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8431 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8432 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8433 address.
8434
8435 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8436 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8437 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8438 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8439 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8440 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8441 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8442 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8443 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8444 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8445
8446 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8447 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8448 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8449 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8450 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8451 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8452 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8453
8454 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8455 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8456 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8457 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8458
8459 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8460 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8461 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8462 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8463 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8464 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008465 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8466 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8467 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8468 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8469 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8470 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008471
8472 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8473 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8474 the request.
8475
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008476 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8477 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8478 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8479
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008480 Example :
8481 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8482 # last 30 minutes
8483 backend pop
8484 mode tcp
8485 balance roundrobin
8486 stick store-request src
8487 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8488 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8489 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8490
8491 backend smtp
8492 mode tcp
8493 balance roundrobin
8494 stick match src table pop
8495 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8496 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8497
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008498 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008499 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008500
8501
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008502stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008503 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8504 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008505 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008507 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008508
8509 Arguments :
8510 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8511 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8512 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8513 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8514
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008515 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8516 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8517 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8518 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8519
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008520 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8521 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8522 instance.
8523
8524 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8525 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8526 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8527 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8528 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8529 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008530 to 32 characters.
8531
8532 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8533 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8534 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008535 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008536 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8537 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008538
8539 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008540 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8541 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008542 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8543 increase.
8544
8545 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008546 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8547 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8548 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008549
8550 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8551 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8552 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8553 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8554 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8555 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8556 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8557 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8558 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8559 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8560 parameter (see below).
8561
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008562 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8563 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8564 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8565 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8566 soft restart.
8567
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008568 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8569 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008570
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008571 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8572 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8573 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8574 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008575 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008576 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008577 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8578 if not expiration delay is specified.
8579
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008580 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8581 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8582 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8583 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008584 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8585 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8586 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8587 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8588 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8589 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8590 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8591 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8592 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8593 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8594 types and their arguments.
8595
8596 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8597 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8598 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8599 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8600
8601 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8602 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8603 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8604 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8605
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008606 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8607 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8608 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8609 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8610 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8611 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8612
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008613 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8614 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8615 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8616 they were received.
8617
8618 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8619 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8620 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8621 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8622 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8623
8624 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8625 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8626 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8627 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8628 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8629
8630 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8631 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8632 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8633
8634 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8635 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8636 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8637 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8638 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8639
8640 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8641 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8642 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8643 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8644 the client side.
8645
8646 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8647 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8648 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8649 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8650 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8651 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8652 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8653
8654 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8655 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8656 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8657 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8658 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8659 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8660 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8661
8662 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8663 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8664 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8665 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8666 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8667 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8668
8669 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8670 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8671 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8672 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8673
8674 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8675 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8676 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8677 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8678 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8679 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8680 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8681 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8682 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8683 recommended for better fairness.
8684
8685 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8686 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8687 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8688 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8689
8690 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8691 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8692 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8693 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8694 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8695 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8696 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8697 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8698 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8699 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008700
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008701 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8702 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008703 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8704 reference it.
8705
8706 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8707 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008708 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8709 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8710 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008711
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008712 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8713 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8714 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8715 something that can be ignored.
8716
8717 Example:
8718 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8719 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8720 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8721 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8722
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03008723 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008724 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008725
8726
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008727stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008728 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8730 no | no | yes | yes
8731
8732 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008733 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008734 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8735 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8736 server is selected.
8737
8738 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8739 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8740 the "stick-table" statement.
8741
8742 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8743 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8744 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8745 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8746
8747 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8748 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8749 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8750 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8751 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8752 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008753 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008754 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8755 rules.
8756
8757 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8758 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8759 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8760 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8761 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8762 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8763 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8764
8765 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8766 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8767 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8768 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8769
8770 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8771 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8772 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8773 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8774 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8775 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008776 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8777 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8778 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8779 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8780 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8781 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8782 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8783 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8784 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008785
8786 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8787
8788 Example :
8789 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8790 backend https
8791 mode tcp
8792 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008793 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008794 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008795
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008796 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8797 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8798
8799 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8800 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8801 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8802
8803 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8804 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008805
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008806 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8807 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8808 # at offset 44.
8809
8810 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8811 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8812
8813 # Learn on response if server hello.
8814 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008815
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008816 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8817 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8818
8819 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8820 extraction.
8821
8822
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008823tcp-check connect [params*]
8824 Opens a new connection
8825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8826 no | no | yes | yes
8827
8828 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8829 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8830 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8831
8832 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8833 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8834 of the sequence.
8835
8836 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8837 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8838 do.
8839
8840 Parameters :
8841 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8842 use the TCP connection.
8843
8844 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8845 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8846 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8847
8848 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8849
8850 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8851
8852 Examples:
8853 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8854 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8855 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8856 option tcp-check
8857 tcp-check connect
8858 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8859 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8860 tcp-check send \r\n
8861 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8862 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8863 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8864 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8865 tcp-check send \r\n
8866 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8867 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8868
8869 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8870 option tcp-check
8871 tcp-check connect port 110
8872 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8873 tcp-check connect port 143
8874 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8875 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8876
8877 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8878
8879
8880tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8881 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8883 no | no | yes | yes
8884
8885 Arguments :
8886 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8887 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8888 binary.
8889 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8890 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8891 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8892
8893 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8894 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8895 with the usual backslash ('\').
8896 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8897 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8898 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8899 used upper or lower case.
8900
8901
8902 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8903
8904 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8905 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8906 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8907 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8908 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8909 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8910 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8911 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8912
8913 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8914 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8915 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8916 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8917 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8918 expression.
8919
8920 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8921 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8922 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8923 this exact hexadecimal string.
8924 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8925
8926 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8927 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8928 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8929 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8930 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8931 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8932 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8933 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8934 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8935 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8936 the null character.
8937
8938 Examples :
8939 # perform a POP check
8940 option tcp-check
8941 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8942
8943 # perform an IMAP check
8944 option tcp-check
8945 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8946
8947 # look for the redis master server
8948 option tcp-check
8949 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008950 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008951 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8952 tcp-check expect string role:master
8953 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8954 tcp-check expect string +OK
8955
8956
8957 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8958 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8959
8960
8961tcp-check send <data>
8962 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8964 no | no | yes | yes
8965
8966 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8967 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8968
8969 Examples :
8970 # look for the redis master server
8971 option tcp-check
8972 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8973 tcp-check expect string role:master
8974
8975 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8976 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8977
8978
8979tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8980 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8981 tcp health check
8982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8983 no | no | yes | yes
8984
8985 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8986 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8987 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8988 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8989 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8990 hexadecimal string.
8991 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8992
8993 Examples :
8994 # redis check in binary
8995 option tcp-check
8996 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8997 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8998
8999
9000 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9001 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9002
9003
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009004tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9005 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9007 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009008 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009009 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9010 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009011
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009012 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009013
9014 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9015 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009016 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9017 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9018 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9019 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9020 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9021 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009022
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009023 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9024 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9025 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9026 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009027
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009028 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009029 - accept :
9030 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9031 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9032 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009033
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009034 - reject :
9035 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9036 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9037 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9038 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9039 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9040 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9041 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9042 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9043 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9044 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9045 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009046 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009047
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009048 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9049 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9050 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9051 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9052 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9053 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9054 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9055 hosts.
9056
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009057 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9058 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9059 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9060 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9061 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9062 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9063 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9064 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9065
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009066 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9067 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9068 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9069 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9070 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9071 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9072 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9073 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9074 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009075 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9076 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009077
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009078 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009079 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009080 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009081 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009082 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9083 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009084 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009085 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9086 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9087 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9088 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9089 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009090
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009091 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009092 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009093 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009094 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9095 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9096 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9097 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009098
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009099 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9100 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9101 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9102 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009104 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9105 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9106 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9107 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9108 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009109 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9110 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9111 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9112 layer7 information is extracted.
9113
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009114 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9115 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9116 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9117 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9118 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009119
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009120 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9121 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9122 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9123 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9124
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009125 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9126 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9127 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9128 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9129 continues.
9130
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009131 - set-src <expr> :
9132 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9133 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9134 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9135 set-src"
9136
9137 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9138 followed by some converters.
9139
9140 Example:
9141
9142 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9143
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009144 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9145 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009146
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009147 - set-src-port <expr> :
9148 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9149 expression.
9150
9151 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9152 followed by some converters.
9153
9154 Example:
9155
9156 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9157
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009158 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9159 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9160 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009161
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009162 - set-dst <expr> :
9163 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9164 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9165 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9166 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9167 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9168
9169 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9170 followed by some converters.
9171
9172 Example:
9173
9174 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9175 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9176
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009177 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9178 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9179
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009180 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9181 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9182 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9183 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9184
9185
9186 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9187 followed by some converters.
9188
9189 Example:
9190
9191 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9192
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009193 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9194 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9195 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9196
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009197 - "silent-drop" :
9198 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9199 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9200 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9201 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9202 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9203 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9204 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9205 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9206 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9207 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9208 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9209 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9210 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9211 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9212 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9213 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9214
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009215 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9216 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9217 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009219 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9220 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9221 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009222
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009223 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009224 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009225 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009226
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009227 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9228 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9229 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009230
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009231 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009232 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9233 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009234
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009235 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9236
9237 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9238
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009239 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9240
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009241 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009242
9243
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009244tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9245 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009247 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009248 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009249 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9250 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009251
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009252 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009253
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009254 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9255 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9256 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9257 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9258 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009259
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009260 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9261 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9262 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9263 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009264 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9265 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9266 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9267 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9268 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9269 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009270 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009271 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009273 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9274 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9275 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9276 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009277
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009278 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009279 - accept : the request is accepted
9280 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9281 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009282 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009283 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009284 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009285 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009286 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009287 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009288 - send-spoe-group <engin-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009289
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009290 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9291 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009292
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009293 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9294 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9295 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9296 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9297 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9298 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009300 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009301 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9302 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009304 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009305 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9306 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9307 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9308 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009309 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9310 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9311 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009312
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009313 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009314 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9315 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9316 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009317
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009318 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009319 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9320 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009321
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009322 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9323 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009324 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009325 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9326 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009327 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009328 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009329 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009330 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9331 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009332 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009333 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9334 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009335
9336 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9337 followed by some converters.
9338
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009339 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9340 <var-name>.
9341
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009342 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9343 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9344 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9345 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9346 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9347
9348 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9349
9350 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9351
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009352 Example:
9353
9354 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009355 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009356
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009357 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009358 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9359 # and reject everything else.
9360 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9361 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009362 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009363 tcp-request content reject
9364
9365 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009366 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9367 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9368 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009369 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009370
9371 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9372 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9373 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009374 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009375 tcp-request content reject
9376
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009377 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009378 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009379 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009380 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009381 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9382 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009383
9384 Example:
9385 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9386 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009387 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009388
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009389 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009390 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009391
9392 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009393 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009394 # protecting all our sites
9395 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009396 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9397 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009398 ...
9399 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9400
9401 backend http_dynamic
9402 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009403 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009404 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009405 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009406 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009407 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009408 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009409
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009410 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009411
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009412 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9413 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009414
9415
9416tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9417 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009419 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009420 Arguments :
9421 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9422 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9423 as explained at the top of this document.
9424
9425 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9426 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9427 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9428 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9429 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9430
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009431 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9432 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9433 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9434 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9435
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009436 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9437 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009438 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009439 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009440 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9441 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9442 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9443 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009444
9445 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9446 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9447 it pass through unaffected.
9448
9449 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9450 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9451 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009452 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009453 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9454 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009455 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9456 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9457 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009458
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009459 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009460 "timeout client".
9461
9462
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009463tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9464 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9466 no | no | yes | yes
9467 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009468 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9469 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009470
9471 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9472
9473 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9474 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9475 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009476 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9477 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009478
9479 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9480
9481 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9482 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9483 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9484 inserted.
9485
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009486 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009487 - accept :
9488 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9489 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9490 the rules evaluation.
9491
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009492 - close :
9493 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9494 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9495 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9496 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9497 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9498 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009499 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009500 protocols.
9501
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009502 - reject :
9503 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9504 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009505 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009506
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009507 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9508 Sets a variable.
9509
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009510 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9511 Unsets a variable.
9512
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009513 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9514 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9515 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9516 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9517
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009518 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9519 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9520 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9521 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9522 continues.
9523
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009524 - "silent-drop" :
9525 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9526 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9527 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9528 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9529 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9530 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9531 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9532 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9533 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9534 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9535 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9536 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9537 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9538 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9539 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9540 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9541
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009542 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
9543 Send a group of SPOE messages.
9544
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009545 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9546 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9547 for changing the default action to a reject.
9548
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009549 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9550 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9551 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9552 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009553 period.
9554
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009555 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9556 declared inline.
9557
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009558 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9559 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009560 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009561 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9562 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009563 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009564 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009565 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009566 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9567 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009568 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009569 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9570 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009571
9572 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9573 followed by some converters.
9574
9575 Example:
9576
9577 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9578
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009579 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9580 <var-name>.
9581
9582 Example:
9583
9584 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9585
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009586 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9587 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9588 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9589 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9590 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9591
9592 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9593
9594 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9595
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009596 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9597
9598 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9599
9600
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009601tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9602 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9604 no | yes | yes | no
9605 Arguments :
9606 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9607 below.
9608
9609 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9610
9611 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9612 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9613 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9614 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9615 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9616 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9617 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9618 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9619 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9620 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9621 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9622 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9623 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9624 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9625 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9626 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9627 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9628 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9629 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9630 instead.
9631
9632 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9633 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9634 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9635 rules which may be inserted.
9636
9637 Several types of actions are supported :
9638 - accept : the request is accepted
9639 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9640 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9641 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9642 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9643 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009644 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009645 - silent-drop
9646
9647 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9648 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9649 sections for a complete description.
9650
9651 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9652 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9653 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9654
9655 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9656 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9657 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9658 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9659 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9660
9661 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9662 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9663
9664 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9665 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9666 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9667
9668 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9669 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9670 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9671
9672 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9673 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9674 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9675
9676 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9677 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9678 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9679
9680 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9681
9682 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9683
9684
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009685tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9686 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9688 no | no | yes | yes
9689 Arguments :
9690 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9691 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9692 as explained at the top of this document.
9693
9694 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9695
9696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009697timeout check <timeout>
9698 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9699 established.
9700
9701 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9702 yes | no | yes | yes
9703 Arguments:
9704 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9705 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9706 as explained at the top of this document.
9707
9708 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9709 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9710 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9711 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009712 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9713 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9714 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009715
9716 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9717 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9718
9719 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9720 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009721 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009722
9723 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9724 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9725 forget about it.
9726
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009727 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9728 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009729
9730
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009731timeout client <timeout>
9732timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9733 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9735 yes | yes | yes | no
9736 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009737 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009738 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9739 as explained at the top of this document.
9740
9741 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9742 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9743 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009744 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9745 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9746 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9747 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009748 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9749 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9750 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009751 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009752 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009753 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9754 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009755 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9756 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009757
9758 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9759 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9760 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9761 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9762 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9763 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9764
9765 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9766 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9767 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9768
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009769 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9770 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009771
9772
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009773timeout client-fin <timeout>
9774 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9776 yes | yes | yes | no
9777 Arguments :
9778 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9779 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9780 as explained at the top of this document.
9781
9782 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9783 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9784 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9785 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9786 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9787 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9788 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9789 down in one direction.
9790
9791 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9792 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9793 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9794
9795 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9796
9797
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009798timeout connect <timeout>
9799timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9800 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9802 yes | no | yes | yes
9803 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009804 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009805 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9806 as explained at the top of this document.
9807
9808 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009809 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009810 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009811 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009812 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9813 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009814
9815 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9816 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9817 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9818 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9819 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9820 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9821
9822 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9823 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9824 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9825
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009826 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9827 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009828
9829
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009830timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9831 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9833 yes | yes | yes | yes
9834 Arguments :
9835 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9836 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9837 as explained at the top of this document.
9838
9839 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9840 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9841 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9842 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9843 once the request has started to present itself.
9844
9845 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9846 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9847 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9848 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9849 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9850
9851 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9852 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9853 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9854 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9855
9856 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9857 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9858 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9859 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9860 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009861 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009862
9863 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9864 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9865 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9866 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9867
9868 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9869
9870
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009871timeout http-request <timeout>
9872 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009874 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009875 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009876 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009877 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9878 as explained at the top of this document.
9879
9880 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9881 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9882 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9883 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9884 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9885 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9886 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009887 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9888 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9889 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9890 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9891 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009892 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9893 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009894
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009895 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9896 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9897 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9898 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9899 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009900 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009901
9902 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9903 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9904 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9905 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9906 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9907
9908 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009909 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9910 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9911 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009912
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009913 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009914 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009915
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009916
9917timeout queue <timeout>
9918 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9920 yes | no | yes | yes
9921 Arguments :
9922 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9923 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9924 as explained at the top of this document.
9925
9926 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9927 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9928 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9929 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9930 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9931
9932 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9933 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9934 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9935 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9936
9937 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9938
9939
9940timeout server <timeout>
9941timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9942 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9944 yes | no | yes | yes
9945 Arguments :
9946 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9947 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9948 as explained at the top of this document.
9949
9950 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9951 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9952 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9953 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9954 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9955 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9956 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9957
9958 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9959 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9960 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9961 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9962 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009963 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009964 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009965 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9966 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9967 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9968 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009969
9970 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9971 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9972 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9973 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9974 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9975 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9976
9977 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9978 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9979 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9980
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009981 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009982
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009983
9984timeout server-fin <timeout>
9985 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9987 yes | no | yes | yes
9988 Arguments :
9989 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9990 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9991 as explained at the top of this document.
9992
9993 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9994 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9995 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9996 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9997 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9998 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9999 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10000 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10001 situations, it should not be needed.
10002
10003 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10004 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10005 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10006
10007 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10008
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010009
10010timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010011 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10013 yes | yes | yes | yes
10014 Arguments :
10015 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10016 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10017 as explained at the top of this document.
10018
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010019 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10020 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10021 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10022 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010023
10024 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10025 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10026 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10027 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010028 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010029
10030 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10031
10032
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010033timeout tunnel <timeout>
10034 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10036 yes | no | yes | yes
10037 Arguments :
10038 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10039 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10040 as explained at the top of this document.
10041
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010042 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010043 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10044 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10045 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
10046 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
10047 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
10048 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10049 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10050 specified.
10051
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010052 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10053 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10054 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10055 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10056 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10057 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10058 state.
10059
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010060 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10061 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10062 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10063 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
10064 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
10065
10066 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10067 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10068 forget about it.
10069
10070 Example :
10071 defaults http
10072 option http-server-close
10073 timeout connect 5s
10074 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010075 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010076 timeout server 30s
10077 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10078
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010079 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010080
10081
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010082transparent (deprecated)
10083 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010085 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010086 Arguments : none
10087
10088 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10089 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10090 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10091 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10092 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10093 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10094 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10095 appropriate server.
10096
10097 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10098
10099 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10100 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10101
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010102 See also: "option transparent"
10103
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010104unique-id-format <string>
10105 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10107 yes | yes | yes | no
10108 Arguments :
10109 <string> is a log-format string.
10110
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010111 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10112 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10113 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10114 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010115
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010116 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10117 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10118 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10119 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10120 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10121 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10122 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10123 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010124
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010125 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10126 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010127
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010128 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010129
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010130 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010131
10132 will generate:
10133
10134 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10135
10136 See also: "unique-id-header"
10137
10138unique-id-header <name>
10139 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10141 yes | yes | yes | no
10142 Arguments :
10143 <name> is the name of the header.
10144
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010145 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10146 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010147
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010148 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010149
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010150 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010151 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10152
10153 will generate:
10154
10155 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10156
10157 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010158
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010159use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010160 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10162 no | yes | yes | no
10163 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010164 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10165 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010166
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010167 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10168 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010169
10170 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10171 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10172 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010173 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10174 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10175 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10176 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010177
10178 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10179 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10180 assign the backend.
10181
10182 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10183 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10184 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10185 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10186 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10187 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10188
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010189 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010190 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010191 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10192 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10193 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10194
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010195 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10196 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10197 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10198 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10199 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10200 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10201 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10202 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10203 cannot be forced from the request.
10204
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010205 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010206 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10207 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10208
10209 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10210 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010211
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010212
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010213use-server <server> if <condition>
10214use-server <server> unless <condition>
10215 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10217 no | no | yes | yes
10218 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010219 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010220
10221 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10222
10223 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10224 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10225 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10226
10227 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10228 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10229 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10230 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10231 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10232 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10233 matches will assign the server.
10234
10235 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10236 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10237 with the next rules until one matches.
10238
10239 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10240 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10241 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10242 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10243
10244 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10245 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10246 stripped.
10247
10248 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10249 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10250 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10251 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10252
10253 Example :
10254 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10255 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10256 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10257 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10258 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10259 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010260 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010261 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10262 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10263
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010264 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010265
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010266
102675. Bind and Server options
10268--------------------------
10269
10270The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10271depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10272settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10273written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10274described in this section.
10275
10276
102775.1. Bind options
10278-----------------
10279
10280The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10281as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10282no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10283parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10284while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10285provided immediately after the setting name.
10286
10287The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10288
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010289accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10290 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10291 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10292 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10293 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10294 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10295 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10296 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10297 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10298 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010299 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10300 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10301 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010302
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010303accept-proxy
10304 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010305 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10306 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010307 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10308 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10309 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10310 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10311 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10312 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10313 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010314 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10315 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010316
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010317allow-0rtt
10318 Allow receiving early data when using TLS 1.3. This is disabled by default,
10319 due to security considerations.
10320
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010321alpn <protocols>
10322 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10323 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10324 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10325 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10326 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10327 initial NPN extension.
10328
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010329backlog <backlog>
10330 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10331 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10332
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010333curves <curves>
10334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10335 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10336 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10337 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10338 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10339 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10340
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010341ecdhe <named curve>
10342 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010343 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10344 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010345
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010346ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010347 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10348 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10349 client's certificate.
10350
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010351ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10352 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10353 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10354 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10355 error is ignored.
10356
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010357ca-sign-file <cafile>
10358 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10359 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10360 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10361 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10362 'generate-certificates' for details.
10363
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010364ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10366 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10367 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10368 'generate-certificates' for details.
10369
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010370ciphers <ciphers>
10371 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10372 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010373 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010374 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10375 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
Daniel Schneller87e43022017-09-01 19:29:57 +020010376 Depending on the compatiblity and security requirements, the list of suitable
10377 ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background information and
10378 recommendations see e. g. (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS)
10379 and (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010380
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010381crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010382 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10383 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10384 to verify client's certificate.
10385
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010386crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010387 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10388 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10389 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10390 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10391 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10392 file.
10393
10394 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10395 are loaded.
10396
10397 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010398 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010399 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10400 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10401 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10402 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10403 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10404 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10405 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010406
10407 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10408 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10409 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10410 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010411 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10412 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010413
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010414 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010415
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010416 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10417 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010418 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010419 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10420 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10421 clients).
10422
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010423 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10424 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10425 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10426 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10427 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10428 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10429 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10430 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10431 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10432 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10433 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10434 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10435 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10436
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010437 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10438 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10439 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10440 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10441 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10442
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010443 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10444 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10445 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10446 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010447
10448 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10449 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10450 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10451 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10452 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10453 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10454 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10455 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10456 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10457
10458 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10459
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010460 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010461 a cert bundle.
10462
10463 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10464 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10465 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10466 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10467 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10468 provide multi-cert support.
10469
10470 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10471
10472 Filename | CN | SAN
10473 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10474 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010475 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010476 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10477 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10478
10479 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10480 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10481 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10482 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010483 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
10484 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
10485 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010486
10487 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10488 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10489
10490 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10491 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10492 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10493
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010494crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010495 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10496 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010497 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010498 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010499
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010500crt-list <file>
10501 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010502 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10503 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010504
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010505 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10506
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010507 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
10508 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010509 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010510 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010511
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010512 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10513 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10514 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10515 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10516 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10517 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10518 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10519 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010520
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010521 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010522 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020010523 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
10524 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
10525 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010526
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010527 crt-list file example:
10528 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010529 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010530 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010531 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010532
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010533defer-accept
10534 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10535 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10536 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10537 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10538 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10539 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10540 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10541 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10542 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10543 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10544 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10545
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010546expose-fd listeners
10547 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10548 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010549 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10550 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010551 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10552
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010553force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010554 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010555 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010556 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010557 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010558
10559force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010560 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010561 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010562 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010563
10564force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010565 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010566 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010567 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010568
10569force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010570 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010571 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010572 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010573
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010574force-tlsv13
10575 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10576 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010577 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010578
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010579generate-certificates
10580 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10581 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10582 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10583 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10584 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10585 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10586 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10587 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10588 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10589 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10590 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10591
10592 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10593 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10594 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10595 certificate is used many times.
10596
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010597gid <gid>
10598 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10599 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10600 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10601 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10602 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10603
10604group <group>
10605 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10606 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10607 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10608 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10609 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10610
10611id <id>
10612 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10613 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10614 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10615 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10616
10617interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010618 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10619 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10620 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10621 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10622 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10623 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10624 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010625
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010626level <level>
10627 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10628 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10629 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10630 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10631 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10632 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10633 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10634 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10635 counters).
10636 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10637 all counters).
10638
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020010639severity-output <format>
10640 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
10641 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
10642 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
10643 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
10644 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
10645 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
10646 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
10647 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
10648 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
10649 rfc5424 convention.
10650
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010651maxconn <maxconn>
10652 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10653 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10654 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10655 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10656 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10657 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10658 eat all memory.
10659
10660mode <mode>
10661 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10662 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10663 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10664 UNIX sockets.
10665
10666mss <maxseg>
10667 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10668 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10669 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10670 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10671 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10672 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10673 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10674 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10675 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10676 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10677 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10678
10679name <name>
10680 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10681 page.
10682
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010683namespace <name>
10684 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10685 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10686 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10687 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10688
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010689nice <nice>
10690 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10691 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10692 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10693 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10694 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10695 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10696 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10697 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10698 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10699 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10700 one for an RDP socket.
10701
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020010702no-ca-names
10703 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10704 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
10705
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010706no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010707 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010708 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010709 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010710 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010711 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10712 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010713
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010714no-tls-tickets
10715 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10716 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10717 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010718 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10719 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010720
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010721no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010723 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010724 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010725 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010726 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10727 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010728
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010729no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010730 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010731 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010732 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010733 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010734 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10735 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010736
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010737no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010738 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010739 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010740 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010741 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010742 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10743 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010744
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010745no-tlsv13
10746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10747 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10748 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10749 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010750 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10751 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010752
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010753npn <protocols>
10754 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10755 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10756 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10757 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010758 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10759 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010760
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010761prefer-client-ciphers
10762 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10763 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10764 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10765
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010766process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10767 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10768 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10769 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10770 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10771 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10772 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10773 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010774 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10775 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10776 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10777 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10778 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10779 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10780 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010781
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010782ssl
10783 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010784 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010785 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10786 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020010787 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
10788 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010789
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010790ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10791 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10792 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10793 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10794
10795ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10796 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10797 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10798 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10799
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010800strict-sni
10801 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10802 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10803 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10804 See the "crt" option for more information.
10805
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010806tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010807 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010808 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10809 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010810 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010811 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10812 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10813 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10814 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10815 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10816 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10817 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10818
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010819tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010820 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010821 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10822 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10823 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10824 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10825 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10826 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10827 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010828 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10829 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10830 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010831
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010832tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10833 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10834 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10835 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10836 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10837 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10838 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10839 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10840 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10841 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10842 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10843
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010844transparent
10845 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10846 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10847 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10848 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10849 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10850 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10851 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10852 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10853 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10854 so check for support with your vendor.
10855
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010856v4v6
10857 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10858 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10859 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10860 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010861 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010862
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010863v6only
10864 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10865 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10866 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010867 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10868 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010869
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010870uid <uid>
10871 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10872 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10873 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10874 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10875 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10876
10877user <user>
10878 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10879 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10880 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10881 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10882 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10883
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010884verify [none|optional|required]
10885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10886 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10887 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10888 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10889 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010890 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10891 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10892 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10893 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010894
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200108955.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010896------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010898The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10899which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10900arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10901settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10902after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10903Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10904address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010906 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010907 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010908
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010909Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10910keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010912The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010913
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010914addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010915 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010916 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10917 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10918 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10919 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10920 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010921
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010922agent-check
10923 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010924 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10925 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10926 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10927 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010928
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010929 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010930 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010931 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10932 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10933 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010934
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010935 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10936 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10937 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10938 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10939 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10940
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010941 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10942 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010943
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010944 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10945 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10946 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010947
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010948 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10949 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10950 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010951
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010952 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10953 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10954 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10955 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10956 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10957 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10958 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010959
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010960 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10961 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010962
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010963 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10964 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10965 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10966 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10967 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10968 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10969 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10970 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10971 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010972
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010973 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10974 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010975 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10976 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10977 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010978 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010979
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010980 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010981 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010982
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010983agent-send <string>
10984 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10985 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10986 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10987 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10988 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10989
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010990agent-inter <delay>
10991 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10992 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10993
10994 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10995 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10996 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10997 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10998 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10999 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11000 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11001 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11002 of backends use the same servers.
11003
11004 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11005
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011006agent-addr <addr>
11007 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11008
11009 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11010 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11011 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11012 hostname, it will be resolved.
11013
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011014agent-port <port>
11015 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11016
11017 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011019backup
11020 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11021 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11022 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11023 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011024 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11025 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011026
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011027ca-file <cafile>
11028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11029 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11030 server's certificate.
11031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011032check
11033 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011034 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11035 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11036 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11037 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11038 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11039 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11040 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011041 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11042 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011043 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11044 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011045
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011046check-send-proxy
11047 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11048 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11049 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11050 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11051 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11052 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11053 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11054
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011055check-sni
11056 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
11057 over SSL.
11058
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011059check-ssl
11060 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11061 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11062 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11063 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011064 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011065 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11066 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
11067 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011068 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11069 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011070
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011071ciphers <ciphers>
11072 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011073 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011074 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11075 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11076 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11077 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11078 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11079 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11080
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011081cookie <value>
11082 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11083 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11084 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11085 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11086 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11087 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11088 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11089
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011090crl-file <crlfile>
11091 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11092 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11093 to verify server's certificate.
11094
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011095crt <cert>
11096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11097 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11098 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11099 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11100 certificate request.
11101
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011102disabled
11103 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11104 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11105 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11106 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11107 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011108 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011109
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011110enabled
11111 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11112 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11113 default value.
11114 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11115 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011116
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011117error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011118 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11119 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11120 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011121
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011122 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011124fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011125 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11126 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11127 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11128
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011129force-sslv3
11130 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11131 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011132 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011133 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011134
11135force-tlsv10
11136 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011137 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011138 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011139
11140force-tlsv11
11141 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011142 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011143 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011144
11145force-tlsv12
11146 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011147 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011148 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011149
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011150force-tlsv13
11151 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11152 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011153 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011155id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011156 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11157 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11158 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011159
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011160init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11161 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11162 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11163 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11164 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11165 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11166 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11167 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11168 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11169 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11170 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11171 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11172 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11173 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11174 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11175 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11176 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11177 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11178 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11179 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11180 historic behaviour.
11181
11182 Example:
11183 defaults
11184 # never fail on address resolution
11185 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11186
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011187inter <delay>
11188fastinter <delay>
11189downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011190 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11191 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11192 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11193 between checks depending on the server state :
11194
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011195 Server state | Interval used
11196 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11197 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11198 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11199 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11200 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11201 or yet unchecked. |
11202 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11203 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11204 | "inter" otherwise.
11205 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011207 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11208 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11209 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11210 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011211 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11212 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11213 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11214 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11215 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011217maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011218 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11219 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11220 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11221 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11222 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11223 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11224 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11225 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11226
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011227maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011228 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11229 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11230 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11231 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11232 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11233 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11234 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11235
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011236minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011237 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11238 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11239 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11240 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11241 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11242 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011243 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011244 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011245
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011246namespace <name>
11247 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11248 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11249 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11250 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11251
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011252no-agent-check
11253 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11254 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11255 default value.
11256 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11257 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11258
11259no-backup
11260 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11261 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11262 default value.
11263 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11264 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11265
11266no-check
11267 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11268 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11269 default value.
11270 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11271 "default-server" "check" setting.
11272
11273no-check-ssl
11274 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11275 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11276 default value.
11277 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11278 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11279
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011280no-send-proxy
11281 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11282 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11283 default value.
11284 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11285 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11286
11287no-send-proxy-v2
11288 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11289 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11290 default value.
11291 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11292 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11293
11294no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11295 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11296 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11297 default value.
11298 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11299 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11300
11301no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11302 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11303 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11304 default value.
11305 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11306 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11307
11308no-ssl
11309 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11310 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11311 default value.
11312 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11313 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11314
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011315no-ssl-reuse
11316 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11317 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11318 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11319 and for paranoid users.
11320
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011321no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011322 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11323 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011324 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011325
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011326 Supported in default-server: No
11327
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011328no-tls-tickets
11329 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11330 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11331 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011332 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11333 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011334 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011335
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011336no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011337 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011338 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11339 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011340 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11341 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011342 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011343
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011344 Supported in default-server: No
11345
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011346no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011347 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011348 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11349 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011350 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11351 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011352 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011353
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011354 Supported in default-server: No
11355
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011356no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011357 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011358 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11359 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011360 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11361 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011362 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011363
11364 Supported in default-server: No
11365
11366no-tlsv13
11367 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11368 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11369 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11370 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11371 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011372 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011373
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011374 Supported in default-server: No
11375
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011376no-verifyhost
11377 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11378 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11379 default value.
11380 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11381 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011382
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011383non-stick
11384 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11385 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11386 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011388observe <mode>
11389 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11390 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11391 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11392 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11393 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11394 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011395 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011396
11397 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11398
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011399on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011400 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11401 Currently, four modes are available:
11402 - fastinter: force fastinter
11403 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11404 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11405 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11406 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11407
11408 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11409
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011410on-marked-down <action>
11411 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11412 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011413 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11414 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11415 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11416 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11417 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11418 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11419 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11420 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011421
11422 Actions are disabled by default
11423
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011424on-marked-up <action>
11425 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11426 Currently one action is available:
11427 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11428 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11429 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11430 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11431 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11432 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11433 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11434 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11435
11436 Actions are disabled by default
11437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011438port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011439 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11440 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11441 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11442 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11443 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11444 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11445
11446redir <prefix>
11447 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11448 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11449 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11450 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11451 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11452 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11453 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11454 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011455 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011456 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11457 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11458 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11459 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11460 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11461
11462 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011464rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011465 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11466 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11467 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11468
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011469resolve-prefer <family>
11470 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11471 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11472 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11473 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11474
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011475 Default value: ipv6
11476
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011477 Example:
11478
11479 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011480
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011481resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11482 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11483 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011484 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011485 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11486 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11487 configured network, another address is selected.
11488
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011489 Example:
11490
11491 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011492
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011493resolvers <id>
11494 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11495 hostname.
11496
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011497 Example:
11498
11499 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011500
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011501 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011502
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011503send-proxy
11504 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11505 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11506 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11507 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011508 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11509 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11510 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11511 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11512 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11513 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11514 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11515 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11516 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11517 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011518 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11519 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011520
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011521send-proxy-v2
11522 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11523 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11524 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11525 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020011526 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
11527 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
11528 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
11529 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011530
11531send-proxy-v2-ssl
11532 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11533 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11534 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11535 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11536 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11537 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11538 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011539 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11540 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011541
11542send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11543 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11544 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11545 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11546 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11547 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11548 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11549 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11550 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011551 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11552 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011554slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011555 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11556 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11557 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11558 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11559 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11560 parameters :
11561
11562 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11563 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11564
11565 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11566 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11567 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11568 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11569
11570 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11571 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11572 seen as failed.
11573
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011574sni <expression>
11575 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11576 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11577 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11578 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020011579 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
11580 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011581 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
11582 "verify" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011583
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011584source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011585source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011586source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011587 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11588 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11589 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11590 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11591
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011592 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11593 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11594 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11595 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11596 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11597 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11598 server.
11599
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011600 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11601 specifying the source address without port(s).
11602
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011603ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011604 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11605 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11606 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11607 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11608 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11609 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011610 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11611 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011612
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011613ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11614 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11615 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11616 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11617
11618ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11619 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11620 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11621 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11622
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011623ssl-reuse
11624 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11625 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11626 default value.
11627 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11628 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11629
11630stick
11631 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11632 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11633 default value.
11634 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11635 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011636
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011637tcp-ut <delay>
11638 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11639 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11640 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011641 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011642 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11643 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11644 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11645 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11646 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11647 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11648 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11649 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11650 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11651
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011652track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011653 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11654 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11655 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11656 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011657 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11658
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011659tls-tickets
11660 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11661 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11662 default value.
11663 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11664 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011665
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011666verify [none|required]
11667 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011668 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011669 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
11670 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
11671 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributs match either
11672 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
11673 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
11674 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
11675 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
11676 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
11677 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
11678 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
11679 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011680
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011681verifyhost <hostname>
11682 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020011683 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
11684 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
11685 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
11686 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
11687 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
11688 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
11689 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
11690 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011691
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011692weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011693 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11694 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11695 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011696 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11697 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11698 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11699 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11700 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11701 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011702
11703
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117045.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11705-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011706
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011707HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11708using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11709configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011710This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11711can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11712workload.
11713This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11714resolution at run time.
11715Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11716carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11717
11718
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117195.3.1. Global overview
11720----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011721
11722As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11723different steps of the process life:
11724
11725 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11726 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11727 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11728
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011729 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
11730 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011731
11732A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11733 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11734 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11735 resolution to know this new IP.
11736
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011737When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
11738HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
11739SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
11740from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
11741will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
11742will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020011743
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011744A few things important to notice:
11745 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11746 first valid response.
11747
11748 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11749 servers return an error.
11750
11751
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200117525.3.2. The resolvers section
11753----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011754
11755This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011756HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
11757contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011758
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011759When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11760uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11761is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11762answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11763
11764When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011765used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011766
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011767 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
11768 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
11769 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011770
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011771 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
11772 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011773
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011774 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
11775 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
11776 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011777
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011778For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
11779following scenarios are possible:
11780
11781 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
11782 ignored
11783
11784 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11785 applied
11786
11787 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11788 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
11789
11790 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
11791 retries the query with a new type
11792
11793 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
11794 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011795
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011796As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
11797a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011798<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011799
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011800
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011801resolvers <resolvers id>
11802 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11803
11804A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11805
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011806accepted_payload_size <nb>
11807 Defines the maxium payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011808 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011809 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
11810 by RFC 6891)
11811
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011812 Note: to get bigger responses but still be sure that responses won't be
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020011813 dropped on the wire, one can choose a value between 1280 and 1410.
11814
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020011815 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
11816
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011817nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11818 DNS server description:
11819 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11820 <ip> : IP address of the server
11821 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11822
11823hold <status> <period>
11824 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11825 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011826 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011827 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011828 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11829 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11830 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11831
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020011832 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011833
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011834resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020011835 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
11836 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
11837 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
11838
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011839resolve_retries <nb>
11840 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11841 giving up.
11842 Default value: 3
11843
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011844 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11845 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11846 type.
11847
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011848timeout <event> <time>
11849 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11850 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11851 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011852 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
11853 other time applied.
11854 Default value: 1s
11855 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
11856 have been received.
11857 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011858 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11859 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11860
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011861 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011862
11863 resolvers mydns
11864 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11865 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11866 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020011867 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011868 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011869 hold other 30s
11870 hold refused 30s
11871 hold nx 30s
11872 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011873 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020011874 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011875
11876
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118776. HTTP header manipulation
11878---------------------------
11879
11880In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11881response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11882request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11883which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011884against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011885
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011886If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11887to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11888but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11889HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11890stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11891because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11892a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11893still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011895This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11896in section 4.2 :
11897
11898 - reqadd <string>
11899 - reqallow <search>
11900 - reqiallow <search>
11901 - reqdel <search>
11902 - reqidel <search>
11903 - reqdeny <search>
11904 - reqideny <search>
11905 - reqpass <search>
11906 - reqipass <search>
11907 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11908 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11909 - reqtarpit <search>
11910 - reqitarpit <search>
11911 - rspadd <string>
11912 - rspdel <search>
11913 - rspidel <search>
11914 - rspdeny <search>
11915 - rspideny <search>
11916 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11917 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11918
11919With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11920is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11921parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11922prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11923Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11924
11925 \t for a tab
11926 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11927 \n for a new line (LF)
11928 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11929 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11930 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11931 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11932 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11933
11934The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11935portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11936above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11937regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
119389 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11939is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11940
11941The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11942after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11943
11944Notes related to these keywords :
11945---------------------------------
11946 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11947 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11948 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11949
11950 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11951 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11952 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11953
11954 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11955 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11956 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11957 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11958 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11959
11960 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11961 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11962 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11963 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11964 useless headers before adding new ones.
11965
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011966 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011967 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11968
11969 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11970 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11971 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11972
11973 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11974 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011975 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011976
11977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119787. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11979----------------------------------
11980
11981Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11982client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11983The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11984these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11985but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11986data called patterns.
11987
11988
119897.1. ACL basics
11990---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011991
11992The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11993content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11994from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11995simple :
11996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011997 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011998 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12000 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012002The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12003adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012004
12005In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12006
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012007 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012008
12009This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12010Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12011and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012012an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12013conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12014as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12015are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012016
12017ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12018'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12019which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12020
12021There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12022performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012024The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12025specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12026this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012027methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12028ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012029
12030Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12031 - boolean
12032 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12033 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12034 - string
12035 - data block
12036
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012037Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12038converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12039would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12040The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12041which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12042
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012043Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12044keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12045fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12046which are summarized in the table below :
12047
12048 +---------------------+-----------------+
12049 | Sample or converter | Default |
12050 | output type | matching method |
12051 +---------------------+-----------------+
12052 | boolean | bool |
12053 +---------------------+-----------------+
12054 | integer | int |
12055 +---------------------+-----------------+
12056 | ip | ip |
12057 +---------------------+-----------------+
12058 | string | str |
12059 +---------------------+-----------------+
12060 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12061 +---------------------+-----------------+
12062
12063Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12064matching method, see below.
12065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012066The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12067 - boolean
12068 - integer or integer range
12069 - IP address / network
12070 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12071 - regular expression
12072 - hex block
12073
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012074The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12075
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012076 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12077 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012078 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012079 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012080 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012081 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012082 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012084The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12085read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12086if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12087lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12088will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12089beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12090a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12091lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12092exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12093
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012094The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12095parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12096ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12097a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12098check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12099
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012100The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12101socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12102file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012104Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12105loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12106
12107 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12108
12109In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12110the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12111case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12112as well.
12113
12114The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12115sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12116do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12117methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12118is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
12119obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
12120followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12121default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12122that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12123string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12124
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012125The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12126By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12127string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12128resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12129server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12130waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12131flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12132function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012134There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12135sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12136be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012137
12138 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12139 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012140 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12141 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12142 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12143 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012144
12145 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12146 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012147 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012148
12149 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012150 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012151
12152 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012153 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012154
12155 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12156 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12157
12158 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12159 binary or string samples.
12160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012161 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12162 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012164 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12165 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12166 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012168 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12169 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012171 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12172 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012174 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12175 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012177 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12178 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012179 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012181 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12182 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12183 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012184
12185For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12186request, it is possible to do :
12187
12188 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12189
12190In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12191buffer, one would use the following acl :
12192
12193 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12194
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012195On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12196possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12197
12198 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012200All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12201criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12202method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12203to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12204criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12205the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012207If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012208the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12209For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012211 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12212 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12213 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12214 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012215
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012216
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012217The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12218types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12219combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12220brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12221default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012223 +-------------------------------------------------+
12224 | Input sample type |
12225 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012226 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012227 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12228 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12229 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012230 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012231 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012232 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012233 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012234 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012235 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012236 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012237 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012238 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012239 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012240 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012241 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012242 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012243 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012244 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012245 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012246 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012247 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012248 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012249 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012250 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012251 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12252 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12253 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012254
12255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122567.1.1. Matching booleans
12257------------------------
12258
12259In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12260Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12261When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12262that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12263
12264Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12265return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12266"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12267
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122697.1.2. Matching integers
12270------------------------
12271
12272Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12273enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12274to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12275
12276Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12277matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12278lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012279
12280For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12281unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12282representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12283
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012284As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12285two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12286instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12287ranges and operators.
12288
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012289For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012290operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12291Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12292of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012293
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012294Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012295
12296 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12297 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12298 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12299 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12300 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12301
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012302For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012303
12304 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12305
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012306This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12307
12308 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12309
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123117.1.3. Matching strings
12312-----------------------
12313
12314String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12315different forms :
12316
12317 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12318 patterns ;
12319
12320 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12321 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12322
12323 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12324 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12325
12326 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12327 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12328
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012329 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012330 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12331 matches.
12332
12333 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12334 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12335 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012336
12337String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12338exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12339characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12340string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12341to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012342before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012343
12344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123457.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12346---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012347
12348Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12349they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12350possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12351passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12352the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012353the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12354match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012355
12356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200123577.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12358-------------------------------------
12359
12360It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12361not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12362a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12363to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12364digits may be used upper or lower case.
12365
12366Example :
12367 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12368 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12369
12370
123717.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12372---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012373
12374IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12375netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12376within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012377host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012378difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12379at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12380does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12381parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012382
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012383The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12384abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12385
12386 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12387 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12388 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12389 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12390 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12391 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12392 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12393 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12394
12395Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12396192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12397
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012398IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12399Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12400trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12401IPv6 patterns.
12402
12403HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12404following situations :
12405 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12406 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12407 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12408 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12409 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12410 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12411 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12412 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12413 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12414 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012416
124177.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12418----------------------------------
12419
12420Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12421combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12422
12423 - AND (implicit)
12424 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12425 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012427A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012429 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012431Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12432indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012434For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12435"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12436requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12437is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12438
12439 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012440 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12441 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12442 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012443
12444To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12445and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12446
12447 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12448 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12449 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12450 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12451
12452 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12453 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12454 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12455 use_backend www if host_www
12456
12457It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12458expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12459be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12460the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12461
12462 The following rule :
12463
12464 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012465 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012466
12467 Can also be written that way :
12468
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012469 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012470
12471It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12472to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12473simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12474sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12475good use is the following :
12476
12477 With named ACLs :
12478
12479 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12480 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12481 monitor fail if site_dead
12482
12483 With anonymous ACLs :
12484
12485 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12486
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012487See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12488keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012489
12490
124917.3. Fetching samples
12492---------------------
12493
12494Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12495against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12496sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12497ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12498of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12499available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12500
12501This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12502Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12503compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12504deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12505
12506The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12507matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12508method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12509indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12510
12511As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12512when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12513mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12514the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12515ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12516
12517Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12518multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12519when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12520incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12521are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12522is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12523all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12524
12525Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12526 - name
12527 - name(arg1)
12528 - name(arg1,arg2)
12529
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012530
125317.3.1. Converters
12532-----------------
12533
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012534Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12535of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12536is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12537was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12538has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12539unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12540
12541These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12542sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12543the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12544support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012545
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012546A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12547support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12548supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12549(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12550bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012552The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012553
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001255451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12555 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12556 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12557 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12558 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12559 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12560
12561 Example :
12562 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12563 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12564 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12565 frontend http-in
12566 bind *:8081
12567 default_backend servers
12568 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12569 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12570
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012571add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012572 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012573 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012574 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12575 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012576 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012577 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12578 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12579 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12580 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12581 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012582 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012583
12584and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012585 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012586 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012587 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12588 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012589 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012590 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12591 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12592 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12593 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12594 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012595 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012596
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012597b64dec
12598 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12599 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12600
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012601base64
12602 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12603 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12604 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12605
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012606bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012607 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012608 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12609 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12610 presence of a flag).
12611
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012612bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12613 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12614 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012615 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012616
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012617cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012618 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12619 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012620
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012621crc32([<avalanche>])
12622 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12623 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12624 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12625 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12626 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12627 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12628 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12629 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12630 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12631 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12632 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12633
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012634da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012635 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12636 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12637 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12638 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012639 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012640 configuration language.
12641
12642 Example:
12643 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012644 bind *:8881
12645 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012646 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012647
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012648debug
12649 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12650 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12651 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12652
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012653div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012654 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12655 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012656 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012657 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12658 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012659 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012660 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12661 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12662 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12663 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012665 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012666
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012667djb2([<avalanche>])
12668 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12669 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12670 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12671 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12672 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12673 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12674 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012675 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12676 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012677
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012678even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012679 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012680 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12681
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012682field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12683 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12684 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12685 list of chars.
12686
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012687hex
12688 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12689 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12690 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12691 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012692
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020012693hex2i
12694 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
12695 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
12696
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012697http_date([<offset>])
12698 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12699 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12700 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12701 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12702 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12703 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012704
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012705in_table(<table>)
12706 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12707 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12708 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12709 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12710 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12711
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012712ipmask(<mask>)
12713 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12714 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12715 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12716 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12717
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012718json([<input-code>])
12719 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12720 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012721 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012722 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12723 of errors:
12724 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12725 bytes, ...)
12726 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12727 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12728
12729 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12730 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12731 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12732 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12733 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12734 are :
12735 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12736 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12737 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12738 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12739 error ;
12740 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12741 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12742
12743 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12744 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12745
12746 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012747 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012748 capture request header user-agent len 150
12749 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012750
12751 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12752 GET / HTTP/1.0
12753 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12754
12755 Output log:
12756 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12757
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012758language(<value>[,<default>])
12759 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12760 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12761 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12762 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12763 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12764 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12765 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12766 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12767 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12768 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12769 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12770 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012771
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012772 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012773
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012774 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12775 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012776
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012777 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12778 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12779 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12780 use_backend spanish if es
12781 use_backend french if fr
12782 use_backend english if en
12783 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012784
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012785lower
12786 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12787 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12788 type. The result is of type string.
12789
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012790ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12791 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12792 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12793 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12794 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12795 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12796 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12797
12798 Example :
12799
12800 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12801 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12802 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12803
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012804map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12805map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12806map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12807 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12808 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12809 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12810 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12811 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12812 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12813 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12814 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012815
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012816 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12817 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12818 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012819
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012820 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012821 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012822
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012823 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12824 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12825 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12826 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012827 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12828 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012829 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12830 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12831 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12832 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12833 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12834 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12835 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12836 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012837 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12838 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12839 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012840 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12841 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12842 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12843 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12844 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012845
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012846 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12847 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12848 the corresponding match text.
12849
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012850 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12851 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12852 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12853 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12854 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012855
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012856 Example :
12857
12858 # this is a comment and is ignored
12859 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12860 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12861 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12862 | | | `---------- value
12863 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12864 | `---------------------------- key
12865 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12866
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012867mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012868 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12869 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012870 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012871 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012872 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012873 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12874 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12875 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12876 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12877 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012878 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012879
12880mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012881 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012882 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12883 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012884 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012885 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012886 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012887 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12888 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12889 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12890 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12891 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012892 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012893
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012894nbsrv
12895 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12896 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12897 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12898 map lookup.
12899
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012900neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012901 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12902 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12903 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12904 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012905
12906not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012907 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012908 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12909 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12910 absence of a flag).
12911
12912odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012913 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012914 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12915
12916or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012917 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012918 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012919 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12920 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012921 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012922 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12923 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12924 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12925 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12926 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012927 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012928
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012929regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012930 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12931 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12932 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12933 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12934 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12935 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12936 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12937 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12938 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12939 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012940 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12941 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12942 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12943 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012944
12945 Example :
12946
12947 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12948 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12949 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12950 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12951
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012952capture-req(<id>)
12953 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12954 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12955
12956 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012957 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12958 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012959
12960capture-res(<id>)
12961 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12962 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12963
12964 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012965 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12966 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012967
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012968sdbm([<avalanche>])
12969 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12970 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12971 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12972 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12973 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12974 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12975 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012976 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12977 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012978
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012979set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012980 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12981 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12982 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012983 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012984 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12985 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012986 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012987 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12988 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012989 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012990 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012991
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020012992sha1
12993 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
12994 sample with length of 20 bytes.
12995
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012996sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012997 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12998 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012999 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013000 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13001 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013002 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013003 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13004 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013005 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013006 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13007 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013008 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013009 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013010
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013011table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13014 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13015 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13016 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13017 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13018
13019
13020table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13021 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13022 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13023 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13024 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13025 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13026 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13027
13028table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13029 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13030 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13031 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13032 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13033 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13034
13035table_conn_cur(<table>)
13036 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13037 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13038 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13039 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13040 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13041
13042table_conn_rate(<table>)
13043 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13044 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13045 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13046 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13047 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13048
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013049table_gpt0(<table>)
13050 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13051 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13052 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13053 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13054 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13055
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013056table_gpc0(<table>)
13057 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13058 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13059 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13060 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13061 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13062
13063table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13066 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13067 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13068 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13069 sample fetch keyword.
13070
13071table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13072 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13073 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13074 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13075 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13076 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13077
13078table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13079 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13080 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13081 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13082 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13083 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13084 keyword.
13085
13086table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13087 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13088 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13089 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
13090 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13091 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13092
13093table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13094 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13095 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13096 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13097 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13098 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13099 keyword.
13100
13101table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13102 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13103 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13104 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
13105 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13106 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13107 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13108 keyword.
13109
13110table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13111 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13112 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13113 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
13114 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13115 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13116 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13117 keyword.
13118
13119table_server_id(<table>)
13120 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13121 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13122 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13123 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13124 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13125 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13126
13127table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13128 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13129 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13130 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
13131 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13132 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13133 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13134 keyword.
13135
13136table_sess_rate(<table>)
13137 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13138 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13139 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13140 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13141 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13142 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13143 keyword.
13144
13145table_trackers(<table>)
13146 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13147 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13148 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13149 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13150 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13151 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13152 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13153 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13154 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13155 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13156
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013157upper
13158 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13159 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13160 type. The result is of type string.
13161
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013162url_dec
13163 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13164 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13165
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013166unset-var(<var name>)
13167 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13168 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13169 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13170 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13171 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13172 response),
13173 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13174 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13175 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13176 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13177
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013178utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13179 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13180 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13181 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13182 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13183 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13184 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13185
13186 Example :
13187
13188 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13189 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13190 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13191
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013192word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13193 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13194 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13195
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013196wt6([<avalanche>])
13197 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13198 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13199 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13200 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13201 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13202 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13203 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013204 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13205 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013206
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013207xor(<value>)
13208 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013209 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013210 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013211 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013212 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013213 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13214 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013215 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013216 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13217 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013218 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013219 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013220
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013221xxh32([<seed>])
13222 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13223 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13224 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13225 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13226 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13227 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13228 as cryptographically secure.
13229
13230xxh64([<seed>])
13231 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13232 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13233 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13234 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13235 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13236 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13237 as cryptographically secure.
13238
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013239
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132407.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013241--------------------------------------------
13242
13243A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13244not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13245"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13246The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13247
13248always_false : boolean
13249 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13250 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13251
13252always_true : boolean
13253 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13254 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13255
13256avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013257 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013258 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13259 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13260 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13261 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13262 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13263 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13264 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13265 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13266 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13267 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13268 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13269 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13270 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013272be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013273 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13274 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13275 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13276 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13277 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013279be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13280 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13281 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13282 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13283 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13284 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13285 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013286
13287 Example :
13288 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13289 backend dynamic
13290 mode http
13291 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13292 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013293
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013294bin(<hexa>) : bin
13295 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13296 of the string.
13297
13298bool(<bool>) : bool
13299 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13300 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013302connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13303 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013304 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013305 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13306 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013307
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013308 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013309 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013310 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13311
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013312 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13313 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013314
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013315 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013316 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013317 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013318 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13319 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013320 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013321 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013322
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013323 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13324 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013325 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013326 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013327
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013328date([<offset>]) : integer
13329 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13330 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13331 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13332 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013333 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13334
13335 Example :
13336
13337 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13338 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013339
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020013340distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
13341 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
13342 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
13343 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
13344 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
13345 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
13346 list of supported tokens.
13347
13348distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
13349 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
13350 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
13351 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
13352 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
13353 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
13354 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
13355 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
13356 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
13357 supported tokens.
13358
13359 Example :
13360 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
13361 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
13362 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
13363 # send large files to the big farm
13364 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
13365
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013366env(<name>) : string
13367 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13368 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13369 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13370 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13371 certain way.
13372
13373 Examples :
13374 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13375 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13376
13377 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13378 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013380fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13381 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013382 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13383 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013384 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13385 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13386 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13387 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13388 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013389
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013390fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13391 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13392 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13393 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013395fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13396 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13397 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13398 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13399 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13400 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13401 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13402 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13403 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013404
13405 Example :
13406 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13407 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13408 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13409 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13410 frontend mail
13411 bind :25
13412 mode tcp
13413 maxconn 100
13414 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13415 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13416 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13417 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013418
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013419hostname : string
13420 Returns the system hostname.
13421
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013422int(<integer>) : signed integer
13423 Returns a signed integer.
13424
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013425ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13426 Returns an ipv4.
13427
13428ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13429 Returns an ipv6.
13430
13431meth(<method>) : method
13432 Returns a method.
13433
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013434nbproc : integer
13435 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13436 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13437 and debugging purposes.
13438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013439nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13440 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13441 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13442 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013443 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13444 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13445 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013446
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013447proc : integer
13448 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13449 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13450 debugging purposes.
13451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013452queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013453 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13454 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13455 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13457 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13458 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13459 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13460 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13461
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013462rand([<range>]) : integer
13463 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13464 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13465 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13466 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13467 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013469srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13470 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13471 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13472 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13473 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13474 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13475 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13476 methods.
13477
13478srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13479 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13480 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13481 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13482 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13483 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13484 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13485 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13486
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020013487srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13488 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
13489 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
13490 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
13491 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
13492 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
13493 fetch methods.
13494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013495srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13496 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13497 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013498 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013499 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13500 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13501 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13502 overloading servers).
13503
13504 Example :
13505 # Redirect to a separate back
13506 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13507 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13508 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13509
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013510stopping : boolean
13511 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13512 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13513 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13514
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013515str(<string>) : string
13516 Returns a string.
13517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013518table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13519 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13520 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13521
13522table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13523 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13524 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13525 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13526
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013527var(<var-name>) : undefined
13528 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013529 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13530 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013531 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013532 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13533 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013534 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013535 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13536 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013537 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013538 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013539
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200135407.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013541----------------------------------
13542
13543The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13544closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13545methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13546sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13547TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013548the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13549counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13550"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013551argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13552the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13553this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013554
13555be_id : integer
13556 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13557 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13558
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013559be_name : string
13560 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13561 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013563dst : ip
13564 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13565 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13566 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13567 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13568 RFC 4291.
13569
13570dst_conn : integer
13571 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13572 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13573 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13574 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13575 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13576 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13577 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13578 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013579
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013580dst_is_local : boolean
13581 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13582 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13583 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13584 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13585 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13586 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13587 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13588 it only once per connection.
13589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013590dst_port : integer
13591 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13592 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13593 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13594 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13595 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13596 an HTTP header.
13597
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013598fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13599 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13600 header.
13601
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013602fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13603 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13604 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13605 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13606 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13607 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13608 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13609
13610fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13611 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13612 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13613 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13614 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13615 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13616 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13617
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013618fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13619 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13620 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13621 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13622 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13623
13624fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13625 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13626 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13627 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13628 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13629
13630fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13631 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13632 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13633 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13634 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13635
13636fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13637 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13638 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13639 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13640 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13641
13642fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13643 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13644 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13645 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13646 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13647
13648fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13649 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13650 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13651 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13652 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013654fe_id : integer
13655 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013656 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013657 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13658
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013659fe_name : string
13660 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13661 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13662 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13663
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013664sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013665sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13666sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13667sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013668 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13669 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13670 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13671
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013672sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013673sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13674sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13675sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013676 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13677 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13678 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13679
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013680sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013681sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13682sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13683sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013684 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13685 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013686 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13687 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13688 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013689
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013690 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013691 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13692 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013693 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13694 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13695 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013696 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13697 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13698
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013699sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013700sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13701sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13702sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013703 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13704 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13705
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013706sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013707sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13708sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13709sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013710 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13711 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13712 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13713
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013714sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013715sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13716sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13717sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013718 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13719 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13720 See also src_conn_rate.
13721
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013722sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013723sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13724sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13725sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013726 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013727 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013728
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013729sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13730sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13731sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13732sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13733 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13734 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13735
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013736sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013737sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13738sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13739sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013740 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13741 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13742 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013743 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13744 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13745 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013746
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013747sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013748sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13749sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13750sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013751 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13752 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13753 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13754
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013755sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013756sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13757sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13758sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013759 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13760 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13761 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13762 src_http_err_rate.
13763
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013764sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013765sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13766sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13767sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013768 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13769 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13770 src_http_req_cnt.
13771
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013772sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013773sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13774sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13775sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013776 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13777 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13778 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13779 src_http_req_rate.
13780
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013781sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013782sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13783sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13784sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013785 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013786 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13787 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13788 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13789 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013790
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013791 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013792 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13793 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013794 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13795
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013796sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013797sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13798sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13799sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013800 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13801 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13802 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013803
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013804sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013805sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13806sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13807sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013808 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13809 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13810 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013811
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013812sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013813sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13814sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13815sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013816 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13817 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13818 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13819 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013820 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013821 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13822
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013823sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013824sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13825sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13826sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013827 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13828 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13829 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13830 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13831 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013832 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013833
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013834sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013835sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13836sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13837sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013838 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13839 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13840 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13841
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013842sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013843sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13844sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13845sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013846 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13847 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013848 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013849 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13850 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013851 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13852 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13853 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013855so_id : integer
13856 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13857 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13858 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013860src : ip
13861 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13862 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13863 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13864 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013865 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13866 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13867 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13868 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013869
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013870 Example:
13871 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13872 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013874src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13875 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13876 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13877 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013878 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013880src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13881 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13882 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013883 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013884 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013886src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13887 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13888 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13889 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13890 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13891 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13892 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013893
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013894 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013895 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13896 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13897 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13898 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013899 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013900 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13901 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013903src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013904 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013905 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013906 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013907 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013909src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013910 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013911 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13912 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013913 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013915src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13916 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13917 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13918 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013919 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013921src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013922 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013923 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013924 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013925 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013926
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013927src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13928 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13929 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13930 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13931 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013933src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013934 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013935 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013936 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13937 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013938 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13939 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13940 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013942src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13943 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13944 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013945 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013946 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013949src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13950 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13951 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13952 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13953 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013954 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013956src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13957 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13958 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13959 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013960 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013962src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13963 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13964 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13965 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013966 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013967 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013969src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13970 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13971 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13972 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013973 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013974 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13975 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013976
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013977 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013978 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013979 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013980 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013981
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013982src_is_local : boolean
13983 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13984 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13985 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13986 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13987 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13988 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13989 once per connection.
13990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013991src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013992 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13993 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13994 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13995 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13996 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013998src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013999 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14000 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14001 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14002 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14003 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014005src_port : integer
14006 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14007 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14008 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14009 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014011src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14012 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014013 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14014 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
14015 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014016 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14019 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
14020 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14021 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14022 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014023 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014025src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14026 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
14027 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
14028 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
14029 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
14030 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
14031 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
14032 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
14033 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014034
14035 Example :
14036 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
14037 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
14038 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
14039 listen ssh
14040 bind :22
14041 mode tcp
14042 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014043 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014044 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014045 server local 127.0.0.1:22
14046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014047srv_id : integer
14048 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
14049 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
14050 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020014051
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140527.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014053----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020014054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014055The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
14056closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
14057when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
14058usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014059future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014060
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001406151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
14062 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14063 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14064 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
14065 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14066 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14067
14068 Example :
14069 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
14070 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
14071 # the request.
14072 frontend http-in
14073 bind *:8081
14074 default_backend servers
14075 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14076 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14077
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014078ssl_bc : boolean
14079 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14080 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
14081 other a server with the "ssl" option.
14082
14083ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
14084 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
14085 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14086
14087ssl_bc_cipher : string
14088 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
14089 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14090
14091ssl_bc_protocol : string
14092 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
14093 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14094
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014095ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014096 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014097 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14098 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020014099
14100ssl_bc_session_id : binary
14101 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
14102 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
14103 if session was reused or not.
14104
14105ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
14106 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
14107 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109ssl_c_ca_err : integer
14110 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14111 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
14112 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
14113 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
14114 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020014115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014116ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
14117 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14118 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
14119 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
14120 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014121
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014122ssl_c_der : binary
14123 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
14124 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14125 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014127ssl_c_err : integer
14128 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14129 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
14130 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
14131 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
14132 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014134ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14135 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14136 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14137 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14138 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14139 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14140 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14141 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14142 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144ssl_c_key_alg : string
14145 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14146 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14147 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014149ssl_c_notafter : string
14150 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
14151 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14152 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014154ssl_c_notbefore : string
14155 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
14156 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14157 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014159ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14160 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14161 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14162 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14163 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14164 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14165 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14166 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14167 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010014168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014169ssl_c_serial : binary
14170 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
14171 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14172 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174ssl_c_sha1 : binary
14175 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
14176 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
14177 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014178 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
14179 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14180
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014181 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014182 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014184ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14185 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14186 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14187 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014189ssl_c_used : boolean
14190 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14191 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014193ssl_c_verify : integer
14194 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14195 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14196 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14197 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014199ssl_c_version : integer
14200 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14201 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014202
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014203ssl_f_der : binary
14204 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14205 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14206 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014208ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14209 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14210 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14211 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14212 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014213 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14215 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14216 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014217
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014218ssl_f_key_alg : string
14219 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14220 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14221 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014223ssl_f_notafter : string
14224 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14225 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14226 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014228ssl_f_notbefore : string
14229 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14230 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14231 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014233ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14234 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14235 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14236 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14237 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14238 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14239 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14240 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14241 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014243ssl_f_serial : binary
14244 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14245 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14246 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014247
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014248ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14249 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14250 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14251 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014253ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14254 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14255 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14256 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014258ssl_f_version : integer
14259 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14260 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14261
14262ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014263 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14264 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14265 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014267 Example :
14268 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14269 listen http-https
14270 bind :80
14271 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14272 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14273
14274ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14275 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14276 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14277
14278ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014279 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014280 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14281 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14282 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14283 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14284 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14285 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14286 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14287 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014289ssl_fc_cipher : string
14290 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14291 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014292
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014293ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14294 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14295 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014296 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014297
14298ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14299 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14300 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014301 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014302
14303ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14304 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14305 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14306 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020014307 avaible with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
14308 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014309
14310ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14311 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14312 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014313 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014314
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014315ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014316 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14317 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014318 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14319 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14320 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14321 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014322
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020014323ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
14324 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
14325 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
14326 wait until the handshake happened.
14327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14329 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014330 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14331 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14332 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14333 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014334
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014335ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014336 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14337 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014339ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014340 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014341 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14342 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14343 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14344 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14345 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14346 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14347 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014349ssl_fc_protocol : string
14350 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14351 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014352
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014353ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014354 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014355 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14356 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014358ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14359 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14360 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14361 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14362 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014364ssl_fc_sni : string
14365 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14366 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14367 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14368 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14369 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14370
14371 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14372 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14373 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014374 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14375 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014377 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014378 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14379 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014381ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14382 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14383 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014384
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014385
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143867.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014387------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014389Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14390sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14391only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14392For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14393be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14394can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14395sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14396for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14397content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014399payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14400 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14401 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14402 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014404payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14405 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14406 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14407 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014408
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014409req.hdrs : string
14410 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14411 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14412 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14413 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14414
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014415req.hdrs_bin : binary
14416 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14417 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14418 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14419 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14420 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14421 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14422
14423 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14424
14425 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14426 str: <int:length><bytes>
14427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428req.len : integer
14429req_len : integer (deprecated)
14430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14431 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14432 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14433 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14434 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14435 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14436 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14437 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014439req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14440 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014441 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14442 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14443 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14444 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014446 ACL alternatives :
14447 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014449req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14450 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14451 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14452 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14453 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014455 ACL alternatives :
14456 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014458 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014460req.proto_http : boolean
14461req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14462 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14463 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14464 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14465 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14466 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14467 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14468 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470 Example:
14471 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14472 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14473 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014474 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14477rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14478 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14479 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14480 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14481 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14482 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14483 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14484 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014486 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14487 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14488 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14489 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14490 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14491 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014493 ACL derivatives :
14494 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496 Example :
14497 listen tse-farm
14498 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14499 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14500 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14501 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14502 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14503 persist rdp-cookie
14504 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14505 # This is only useful makes sense if
14506 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14507 stick-table type string size 204800
14508 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14509 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14510 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014512 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14513 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014515req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14516rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14517 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14518 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14519 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14520 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014522 ACL derivatives :
14523 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014524
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014525req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14526 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14527 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014528 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14529 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14530 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14531 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14532 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014534req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14535req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14536 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14537 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14538 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14539 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14540 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14541 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14542 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014544req.ssl_sni : string
14545req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14546 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14547 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14548 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14549 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14550 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14551 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14552 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14553 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14554 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14555 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14556 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14557 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014558
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014559 ACL derivatives :
14560 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014562 Examples :
14563 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14564 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14565 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14566 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14567 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014568
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014569req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14570 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14571 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14572 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14573 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14574 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14575 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14576 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14577 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14578 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014580req.ssl_ver : integer
14581req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14582 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14583 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14584 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14585 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14586 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14587 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14588 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14589 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14590 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014592 ACL derivatives :
14593 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014594
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014595res.len : integer
14596 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14597 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14598 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14599 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14600 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14601 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14602 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14603 content inspection.
14604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014605res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14606 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014607 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14608 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14609 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14610 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014612res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14613 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14614 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14615 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14616 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014618 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014619
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014620res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14621rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14622 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14623 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14624 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14625 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14626 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14627 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14628 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014630wait_end : boolean
14631 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14632 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14633 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14634 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14635 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14636 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14637 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14638 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014639
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014640 Examples :
14641 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14642 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14643 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014645 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14646 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14647 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14648 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14649 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14650 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14651 tcp-request content reject
14652
14653
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200146547.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014655--------------------------------------
14656
14657It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14658This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14659data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14660its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14661HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14662content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14663to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14664more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14665response are indexed.
14666
14667base : string
14668 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14669 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14670 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14671 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14672 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14673 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14674 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14675 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14676
14677 ACL derivatives :
14678 base : exact string match
14679 base_beg : prefix match
14680 base_dir : subdir match
14681 base_dom : domain match
14682 base_end : suffix match
14683 base_len : length match
14684 base_reg : regex match
14685 base_sub : substring match
14686
14687base32 : integer
14688 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14689 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14690 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014691 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14692 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14693 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014694
14695base32+src : binary
14696 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14697 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14698 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14699 per-URL counters.
14700
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014701capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14702 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14703 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14704 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14705
14706capture.req.method : string
14707 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14708 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14709 because it's allocated.
14710
14711capture.req.uri : string
14712 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14713 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14714 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14715 allocated.
14716
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014717capture.req.ver : string
14718 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14719 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14720 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14721
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014722capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14723 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14724 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14725 The first entry is an index of 0.
14726 See also: "capture response header"
14727
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014728capture.res.ver : string
14729 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14730 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14731 persistent flag.
14732
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014733req.body : binary
14734 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14735 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14736 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14737 the first chunk is analyzed.
14738
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014739req.body_param([<name>) : string
14740 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14741 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14742 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14743 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14744 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14745 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14746 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14747 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14748 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14749 given.
14750
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014751req.body_len : integer
14752 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14753 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14754 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14755 "option http-buffer-request".
14756
14757req.body_size : integer
14758 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14759 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14760 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14761 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14762 "option http-buffer-request".
14763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014764req.cook([<name>]) : string
14765cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14766 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14767 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14768 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14769 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14770 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14771 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14772 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14773 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14774
14775 ACL derivatives :
14776 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14777 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14778 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14779 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14780 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14781 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14782 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14783 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014785req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14786cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14787 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14788 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014790req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14791cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14792 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14793 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14794 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14795 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014797cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14798 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14799 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14800 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14801 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014802 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014803 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14804 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14805 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14806 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014808hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14809 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14810 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14811 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14812 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014813 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14816 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14817 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14818 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14819 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14820 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14821 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14822 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14823 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014825req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14826 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14827 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14828 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14829 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14832 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14833 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14834 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14835 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14836 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14837 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14838 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14839 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014840 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014841 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14842 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014844 ACL derivatives :
14845 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14846 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14847 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14848 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14849 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14850 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14851 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14852 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14853
14854req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14855hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14856 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14857 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14858 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14859 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14860 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14861 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14862 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14863 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14864 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14865
14866req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14867hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14868 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14869 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14870 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14871 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14872 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14873 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14874 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14875 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14876
14877req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14878hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14879 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14880 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14881 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14882 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14883 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14884 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14885 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14886
14887http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14888 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14889 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14890 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14891 basic auth is supported.
14892
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014893http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14894 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14895 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14896 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14897 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014898 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14899 basic auth is supported.
14900
14901 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014902 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14903 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14904 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14905 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014906
14907http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014908 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14909 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014910 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14911 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014913method : integer + string
14914 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14915 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14916 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14917 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14918 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14919 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14920 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014922 ACL derivatives :
14923 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014925 Example :
14926 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14927 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14928 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014930path : string
14931 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14932 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14933 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14934 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14935 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14936 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14937 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939 ACL derivatives :
14940 path : exact string match
14941 path_beg : prefix match
14942 path_dir : subdir match
14943 path_dom : domain match
14944 path_end : suffix match
14945 path_len : length match
14946 path_reg : regex match
14947 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014948
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014949query : string
14950 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14951 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14952 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14953 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014954 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014955 which stops before the question mark.
14956
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014957req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14958 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14959 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14960 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14961 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014963req.ver : string
14964req_ver : string (deprecated)
14965 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14966 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14967 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969 ACL derivatives :
14970 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014972res.comp : boolean
14973 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14974 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14975 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014977res.comp_algo : string
14978 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14979 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14980 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014982res.cook([<name>]) : string
14983scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14984 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14985 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14986 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014988 ACL derivatives :
14989 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014991res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14992scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14993 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14994 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14995 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014997res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14998scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14999 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15000 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
15001 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15004 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15005 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15006 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15007 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15008 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
15009 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
15010 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
15011 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
15012 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015014res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15015 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15016 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15017 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15018 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
15019 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015021res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15022shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
15023 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
15024 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
15025 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
15026 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
15027 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
15028 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
15029 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
15030 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015032 ACL derivatives :
15033 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15034 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15035 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15036 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15037 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15038 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15039 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15040 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15041
15042res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15043shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15044 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
15045 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15046 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
15047 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
15048 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015050res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15051shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15052 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
15053 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
15054 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
15055 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
15056 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
15057 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015058
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010015059res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
15060 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
15061 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
15062 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
15063 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
15064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015065res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15066shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15067 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
15068 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15069 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
15070 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
15071 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
15072 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015074res.ver : string
15075resp_ver : string (deprecated)
15076 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
15077 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015079 ACL derivatives :
15080 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010015081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015082set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15083 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
15084 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015085 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015086 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
15089 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015091status : integer
15092 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
15093 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
15094 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015095
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020015096unique-id : string
15097 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
15098 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
15099 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
15100 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
15101 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
15102 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
15103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015104url : string
15105 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
15106 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
15107 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
15108 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
15109 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
15110 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
15111 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015113 ACL derivatives :
15114 url : exact string match
15115 url_beg : prefix match
15116 url_dir : subdir match
15117 url_dom : domain match
15118 url_end : suffix match
15119 url_len : length match
15120 url_reg : regex match
15121 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015123url_ip : ip
15124 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
15125 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
15126 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
15127 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
15128 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
15129 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15130 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015132url_port : integer
15133 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
15134 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
15135 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
15136 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015137
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015138urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
15139url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015140 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
15141 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015142 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
15143 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
15144 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
15145 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015146 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
15147 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020015148 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
15149 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015151 ACL derivatives :
15152 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
15153 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
15154 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
15155 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
15156 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
15157 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
15158 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
15159 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015160
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015162 Example :
15163 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
15164 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
15165 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
15166 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020015167
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015168urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015169 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
15170 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
15171 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020015172
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020015173url32 : integer
15174 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
15175 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
15176 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
15177 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
15178 is an unsigned integer.
15179
15180url32+src : binary
15181 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
15182 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
15183 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15184
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151867.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015187---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015188
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015189Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15190every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015191order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015193ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15194---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015195FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015196HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015197HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15198HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015199HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15200HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15201HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15202HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15203LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015204METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015205METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015206METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15207METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15208METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15209METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015210METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015211METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015212RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015213REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015214TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015215WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15216---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015217
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152198. Logging
15220----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015221
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015222One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15223provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15224very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15225provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15226state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015227to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015228headers.
15229
15230In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15231about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15232send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15233
15234 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15235 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15236 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15237 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15238 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015239 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15240 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015241
15242The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15243allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15244as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15245while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15246real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15247delay.
15248
15249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152508.1. Log levels
15251---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015252
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015253TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015254source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015255HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15256in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15257track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15258syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15259about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015260
15261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152628.2. Log formats
15263----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015264
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015265HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015266and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15267slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15268options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015269
15270 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15271 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15272 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15273 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15274 extents.
15275
15276 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15277 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15278 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15279 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15280 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15281
15282 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15283 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15284 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15285 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15286 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15287
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015288 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15289 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15290 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15291 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15292
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015293 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15294
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015295Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15296specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15297field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15298servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15299always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15300identifier.
15301
15302Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15303 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15304 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15305 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15306 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15307
15308
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153098.2.1. Default log format
15310-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015311
15312This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15313as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15314format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15315
15316 Example :
15317 listen www
15318 mode http
15319 log global
15320 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15321
15322 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15323 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15324 (www/HTTP)
15325
15326 Field Format Extract from the example above
15327 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15328 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15329 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15330 4 'to' to
15331 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15332 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15333
15334Detailed fields description :
15335 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15336 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15337 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15338 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15339 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15340 and processed the connection.
15341 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15342
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015343In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15344"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15345connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15346
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015347It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15348will eventually disappear.
15349
15350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153518.2.2. TCP log format
15352---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015353
15354The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15355is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15356information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15357counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15358emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15359environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15360the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15361sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015362specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15363not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15364fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15365marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015366
15367 Example :
15368 frontend fnt
15369 mode tcp
15370 option tcplog
15371 log global
15372 default_backend bck
15373
15374 backend bck
15375 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15376
15377 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15378 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15379 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15380
15381 Field Format Extract from the example above
15382 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15383 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15384 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15385 4 frontend_name fnt
15386 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15387 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15388 7 bytes_read* 212
15389 8 termination_state --
15390 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15391 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15392
15393Detailed fields description :
15394 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015395 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15396 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15397 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015398 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15399 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15400 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015401
15402 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015403 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15404 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15405 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015406
15407 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15408 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15409 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15410 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15411
15412 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15413 and processed the connection.
15414
15415 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15416 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15417 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15418 applications.
15419
15420 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15421 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15422 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15423 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15424 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15425
15426 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15427 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15428 See "Timers" below for more details.
15429
15430 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15431 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15432 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15433 "Timers" below for more details.
15434
15435 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015436 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015437 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15438 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15439 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15440 details.
15441
15442 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15443 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15444 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15445 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15446 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15447
15448 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15449 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15450 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15451 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15452 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15453 for more details.
15454
15455 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015456 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015457 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15458 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15459 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015460 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015461
15462 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15463 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15464 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15465 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15466 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15467 caused by a denial of service attack.
15468
15469 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15470 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15471 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15472 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15473 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15474 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15475 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15476 denial of service attack.
15477
15478 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15479 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15480 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15481 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15482 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15483 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15484 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15485 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15486 be processed than on other servers.
15487
15488 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15489 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15490 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15491 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15492 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15493 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15494 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15495 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15496 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15497 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15498 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15499 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15500 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15501
15502 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15503 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15504 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15505 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15506 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15507 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15508 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15509 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15510
15511 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15512 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15513 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15514 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15515 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15516 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15517 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15518 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15519 occurs.
15520
15521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155228.2.3. HTTP log format
15523----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015524
15525The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15526is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15527the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15528are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15529emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15530generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15531"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15532which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015533frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15534is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015535
15536Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15537slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15538with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15539
15540 Example :
15541 frontend http-in
15542 mode http
15543 option httplog
15544 log global
15545 default_backend bck
15546
15547 backend static
15548 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15549
15550 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15551 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15552 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015553 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015554
15555 Field Format Extract from the example above
15556 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15557 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015558 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015559 4 frontend_name http-in
15560 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015561 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015562 7 status_code 200
15563 8 bytes_read* 2750
15564 9 captured_request_cookie -
15565 10 captured_response_cookie -
15566 11 termination_state ----
15567 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15568 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15569 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15570 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15571 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015572
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015573Detailed fields description :
15574 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015575 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15576 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15577 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015578 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15579 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15580 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015581
15582 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015583 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15584 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15585 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015586
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015587 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15588 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015589
15590 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15591 and processed the connection.
15592
15593 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15594 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15595 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15596
15597 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15598 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15599 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15600 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15601 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15602 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15603
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015604 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15605 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15606 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15607 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15608 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15609 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15610 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015611
15612 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15613 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15614 See "Timers" below for more details.
15615
15616 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15617 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15618 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15619 below for more details.
15620
15621 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15622 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15623 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15624 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15625 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15626 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15627 for more details.
15628
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015629 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15630 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15631 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15632 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15633 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15634 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15635 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15636 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015637
15638 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15639 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15640 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15641
15642 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15643 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15644 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15645 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15646 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15647 overflowing.
15648
15649 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15650 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15651 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15652 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15653 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15654 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15655 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15656 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15657
15658 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15659 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15660 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15661 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15662 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15663 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15664 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15665 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15666
15667 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15668 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15669 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15670 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15671 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15672 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15673 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15674
15675 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015676 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015677 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15678 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15679 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015680 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015681 system.
15682
15683 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15684 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15685 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15686 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15687 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15688 caused by a denial of service attack.
15689
15690 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15691 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15692 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15693 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15694 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15695 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15696 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15697 denial of service attack.
15698
15699 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15700 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15701 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15702 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15703 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15704 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15705 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15706 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15707 processed than on other servers.
15708
15709 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15710 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15711 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15712 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15713 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15714 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15715 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15716 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15717 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15718 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15719 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15720 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15721 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15722
15723 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15724 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15725 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15726 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15727 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15728 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15729 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15730 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15731
15732 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15733 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15734 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15735 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15736 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15737 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15738 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15739 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15740 occurs.
15741
15742 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15743 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15744 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15745 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15746 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15747 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15748 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15749 cookies" below for more details.
15750
15751 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15752 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15753 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15754 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15755 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15756 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15757 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15758 and cookies" below for more details.
15759
15760 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15761 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15762 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15763 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15764 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15765 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15766 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15767 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15768
15769
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200157708.2.4. Custom log format
15771------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015772
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015773The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015774mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015775
15776HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15777Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15778separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15779prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15780
15781Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15782variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015783("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015784
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015785If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015786as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015787less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15788the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15789
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015790Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015791In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015792in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015793
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015794Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15795'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15796https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15797such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15798
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015799Flags are :
15800 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015801 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015802 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15803 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015804
15805 Example:
15806
15807 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15808 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15809
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015810 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15811
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015812At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15813
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015814 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15815 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015816
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015817the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015818
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015819 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15820 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15821 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015822
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015823and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15824
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015825 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15826 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015827
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015828Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15829
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015830 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015831 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015832 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15833 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15834 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015835 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15836 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15837 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015838 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015839 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15840 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015841 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015842 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15843 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015844 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015845 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015846 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015847 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015848 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015849 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015850 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015851 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15852 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15853 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15854 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15855 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015856 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015857 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15858 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015859 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015860 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15861 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015862 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15863 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15864 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015865 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015866 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15867 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015868 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015869 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15870 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15871 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015872 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015873 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015874 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15875 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15876 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15877 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015878 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015879 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015880 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015881 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015882 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015883 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015884 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15885 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15886 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015887 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015888 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15889 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015890 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015891 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15892 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15893 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015894 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015895 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015896 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015897
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015898 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015899
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015900
159018.2.5. Error log format
15902-----------------------
15903
15904When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15905protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15906By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15907"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15908will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15909logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15910
15911The format looks like this :
15912
15913 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15914 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15915 Connection error during SSL handshake
15916
15917 Field Format Extract from the example above
15918 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15919 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15920 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15921 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15922 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15923
15924These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15925failures.
15926
15927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159288.3. Advanced logging options
15929-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015930
15931Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15932just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15933options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15934for more information about their usage.
15935
15936
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159378.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15938------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015939
15940It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15941haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15942commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15943monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15944ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15945
15946 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15947 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15948 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15949 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15950
15951 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15952 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15953 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015954 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015955 such as other load-balancers.
15956
15957 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15958 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15959 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15960
15961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159628.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15963----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015964
15965The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15966what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15967or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15968"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15969just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15970log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15971after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15972is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15973with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15974with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15975
15976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159778.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15978------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015979
15980Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15981for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15982"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15983retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15984raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15985a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15986file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15987you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15988"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15989
15990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159918.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15992--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015993
15994Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15995multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15996them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15997"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15998logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15999error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
16000and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
16001too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
16002useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
16003alternative.
16004
16005
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160068.4. Timing events
16007------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016008
16009Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
16010reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
16011the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
16012frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016013mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
16014addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
16015
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010016016Timings events in HTTP mode:
16017
16018 first request 2nd request
16019 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
16020 t tr t tr ...
16021 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
16022 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
16023 :<---- Tq ---->: :
16024 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
16025 :<--------- Ta --------->:
16026
16027Timings events in TCP mode:
16028
16029 TCP session
16030 |<----------------->|
16031 t t
16032 ---|----|----|----|----|---
16033 | Th Tw Tc Td |
16034 |<------ Tt ------->|
16035
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016036 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
16037 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
16038 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
16039 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
16040 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
16041 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
16042 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016043
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016044 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
16045 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
16046 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
16047 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
16048 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
16049 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
16050 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
16051 nothing was received on the connection.
16052
16053 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
16054 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
16055 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
16056 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
16057 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
16058 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
16059 request typed by hand during a test.
16060
16061 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
16062 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
16063 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
16064 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
16065 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
16066 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
16067 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016068
16069 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
16070 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
16071 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
16072 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
16073 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
16074
16075 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
16076 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
16077 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
16078 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
16079 connection never established.
16080
16081 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
16082 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
16083 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
16084 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
16085 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
16086 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
16087 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
16088 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
16089 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
16090 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
16091 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
16092
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016093 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
16094 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
16095 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
16096 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
16097 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
16098 by subtracting other timers when valid :
16099
16100 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
16101
16102 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
16103 "Ta" can never be negative.
16104
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016105 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
16106 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016107 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
16108 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016109 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016110
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016111 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016112
16113 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016114 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
16115 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016116
16117These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
16118protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
16119that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016120due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
16121"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
16122that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016123
16124Most common cases :
16125
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016126 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
16127 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
16128 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
16129 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
16130 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
16131 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
16132 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
16133 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
16134 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
16135 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
16136 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020016137 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016138
16139 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
16140 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
16141 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
16142 of ms on remote networks.
16143
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016144 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
16145 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
16146 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016147
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016148 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
16149 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
16150 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
16151 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
16152 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
16153 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
16154 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
16155 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
16156 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016157
16158Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
16159
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016160 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016161 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016162 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016163
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016164 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016165 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
16166 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
16167
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016168 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016169 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
16170 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
16171 flags.
16172
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016173 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
16174 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016175 Check the session termination flags, then check the
16176 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
16177 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
16178 the client connection was maintained open.
16179
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016180 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016181 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016182 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016183 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16184
16185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161868.5. Session state at disconnection
16187-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016188
16189TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16190"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
161912-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16192each of which has a special meaning :
16193
16194 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16195 session to terminate :
16196
16197 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16198
16199 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16200 server explicitly refused it.
16201
16202 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16203 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16204 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16205 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016206 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16207
16208 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16209 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016210
16211 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16212 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16213 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16214 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16215 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16216
16217 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16218 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16219 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16220 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16221 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16222
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016223 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16224 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16225
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016226 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16227 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16228 backup connections when going up.
16229
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016230 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16231
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016232 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16233 send or receive data.
16234
16235 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16236 send or receive data.
16237
16238 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16239 with nothing left in the buffers.
16240
16241 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16242
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016243 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016244 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16245
16246 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16247 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16248 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16249 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16250 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16251
16252 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16253 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16254
16255 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16256 server (HTTP only).
16257
16258 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16259
16260 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16261 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16262 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16263
16264 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16265 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16266 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16267
16268 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16269
16270 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16271 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16272
16273 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16274 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16275 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16276
16277 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16278 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016279 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16280 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016281
16282 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16283 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16284 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16285 another server.
16286
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016287 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016288 server.
16289
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016290 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16291 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16292 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16293 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16294
16295 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16296 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16297 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16298 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16299
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016300 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16301 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16302 "use-server" rule).
16303
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016304 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16305
16306 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16307 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16308
16309 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16310
16311 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16312 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16313 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16314
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016315 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16316 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016317 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016318 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16319 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16320
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016321 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16322
16323 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16324 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16325
16326 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16327
16328 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16329
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016330The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16331was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016332helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16333starvation, attacks, etc...
16334
16335The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16336alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16337easier finding and understanding.
16338
16339 Flags Reason
16340
16341 -- Normal termination.
16342
16343 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16344 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16345 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16346 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16347
16348 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16349 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16350 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16351 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16352 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16353 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016354
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016355 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16356 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016357 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016358
16359 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16360 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16361 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16362
16363 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16364 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16365 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16366 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16367 the server takes too long to respond.
16368
16369 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16370 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16371 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16372 long a time to respond.
16373
16374 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16375 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16376 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16377 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016378 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16379 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016380
16381 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16382 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16383 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16384 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16385 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016386 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016387 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16388 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16389 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16390 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16391 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16392 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16393 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16394 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16395 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16396 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16397 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16398 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016399
16400 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16401 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016402 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16403 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16404 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16405 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016406
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016407 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16408 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16409
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016410 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016411 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16412 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16413 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16414 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16415 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16416
16417 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16418 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16419 503 or 504 here.
16420
16421 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16422 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16423 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16424 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16425 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16426
16427 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16428 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016429 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016430 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16431 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16432
16433 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16434 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16435 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16436 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16437 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16438 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16439 between haproxy and the server.
16440
16441 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16442 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16443 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16444 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16445 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16446 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16447 solution is to fix the application.
16448
16449 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16450 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16451 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16452 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16453 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16454 external attacks.
16455
16456 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16457 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016458 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016459 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16460 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16461
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016462 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16463 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16464 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016465 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16466 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016467
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016468 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16469 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16470 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16471 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016472 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16473 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16474 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16475 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16476 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016477
16478 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16479 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16480 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16481 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16482
16483 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16484 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16485 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16486 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16487
16488 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16489 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16490 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16491 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16492
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016493The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16494persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16495important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16496re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16497
16498 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16499
16500 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16501 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16502 set on a GET request.
16503
16504 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16505 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016506 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016507 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16508
16509 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16510 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16511 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16512
16513 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16514 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16515 already got a cookie.
16516
16517 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16518 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16519 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16520 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16521 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16522
16523 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16524 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16525 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16526
16527 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16528 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16529 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16530
16531 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16532 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16533
16534 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16535 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16536 then advertised in the response.
16537
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016538
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165398.6. Non-printable characters
16540-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016541
16542In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16543consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16544converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16545prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16546being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16547escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16548is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16549'}' when logging headers.
16550
16551Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16552issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16553containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16554
16555Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16556the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16557performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16558
16559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165608.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16561---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016562
16563Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16564achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016565section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016566cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16567the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16568the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016569locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016570not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16571user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16572a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16573wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16574
16575 Examples :
16576 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16577 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16578
16579 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16580 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16581
16582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165838.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16584---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016585
16586Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16587proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16588the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16589server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16590
16591Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16592response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016593section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016594
16595It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016596time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16597appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016598are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16599and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16600follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16601request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16602in the logs.
16603
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016604As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16605frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16606an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16607
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016608 Example :
16609 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16610 listen proxy-out
16611 mode http
16612 option httplog
16613 option logasap
16614 log global
16615 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16616
16617 # log the name of the virtual server
16618 capture request header Host len 20
16619
16620 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16621 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16622
16623 # log the beginning of the referrer
16624 capture request header Referer len 20
16625
16626 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16627 capture response header Server len 20
16628
16629 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16630 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16631
16632 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16633 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16634
16635 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16636 capture response header Via len 20
16637
16638 # log the URL location during a redirection
16639 capture response header Location len 20
16640
16641 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16642 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16643 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16644 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16645 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16646
16647 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16648 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16649 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16650 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016651 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016652
16653 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16654 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16655 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16656 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16657 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016658 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016659
16660
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200166618.9. Examples of logs
16662---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016663
16664These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16665them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16666reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16667
16668 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16669 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16670 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16671
16672 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16673 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16674
16675 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16676 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16677 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16678
16679 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16680 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16681
16682 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16683 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16684 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16685
16686 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016687 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016688 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16689 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16690
16691 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16692 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16693 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16694
16695 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16696 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016697 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016698 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16699 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16700 to return the 502 and not the server.
16701
16702 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016703 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016704
16705 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16706 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16707 Nothing was sent to any server.
16708
16709 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16710 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16711
16712 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16713 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16714 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16715 send a 408 return code to the client.
16716
16717 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16718 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16719
16720 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16721 5 seconds ("c----").
16722
16723 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16724 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016725 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016726
16727 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016728 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016729 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16730 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16731 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16732 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16733 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016734
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016735
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200167369. Supported filters
16737--------------------
16738
16739Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16740accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16741unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16742
16743See also : "filter"
16744
167459.1. Trace
16746----------
16747
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016748filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016749
16750 Arguments:
16751 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16752 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16753
16754 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16755 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16756 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16757 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16758
16759 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16760 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16761 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16762 amount of the parsed data.
16763
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016764 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16765
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016766This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16767callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16768information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16769filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16770
16771Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16772tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16773a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16774
16775
167769.2. HTTP compression
16777---------------------
16778
16779filter compression
16780
16781The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16782keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16783when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16784use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16785used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16786filters evaluation order.
16787
16788See also : "compression"
16789
16790
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200167919.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16792--------------------------------------------
16793
16794filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16795
16796 Arguments :
16797
16798 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16799 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16800 parsed.
16801
16802 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16803 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16804 part must be placed in its own scope.
16805
16806The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16807external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16808streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16809exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16810also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16811
16812SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16813the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16814
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016815For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016816"doc/SPOE.txt".
16817
16818Important note:
16819 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16820 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16821
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016822/*
16823 * Local variables:
16824 * fill-column: 79
16825 * End:
16826 */